blob: fa1ce7a21c570d77dcd88147a3ebe43cacf84773 [file] [log] [blame]
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner0bc735f2007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall2d887082010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregore737f502010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
17#include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbarc4a1dea2008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +000022#include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000023#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Narofff494b572008-05-29 21:12:08 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +000026#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000029#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000030#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000031#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
32#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
John McCall19510852010-08-20 18:27:03 +000033#include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
34#include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
35#include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +000036#include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
John McCall19510852010-08-20 18:27:03 +000037#include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
John McCall7cd088e2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000038#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000039using namespace clang;
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +000040using namespace sema;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000041
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +000042
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000043/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
44/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
45///
46/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
47/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
48/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
49/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
50/// function is being used.
51///
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000052/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
53/// decls.
54///
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000055/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
56/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000057///
John McCall54abf7d2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000058bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000059 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Fariborz Jahanianc4b35cf2010-10-06 21:18:44 +000060 if (const DeprecatedAttr *DA = D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>()) {
61 const char *Message =
Fariborz Jahaniandf9fb912010-10-06 22:20:08 +000062 DA->getMessage().empty() ? 0 : DA->getMessage().data();
Fariborz Jahanianc4b35cf2010-10-06 21:18:44 +000063 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, Message, Loc);
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000064 }
65
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000066 // See if the decl is unavailable
67 if (D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
Ted Kremenek042411c2010-07-21 20:43:11 +000068 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000069 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
70 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +000071
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000072 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000073 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000074 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
75 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
76 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
77 return true;
78 }
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000079 }
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000080
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000081 return false;
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000082}
83
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +000084/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000085/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +000086/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
87///
88void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000089 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000090 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000091 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000092 return;
Douglas Gregor92e986e2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000093
94 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
95 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +000096 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
97 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000098
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +000099 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
100 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000101 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000102 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
103 int isMethod = 0;
104 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
105 // skip over named parameters.
106 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
107 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
108 if (nullPos)
109 --nullPos;
110 else
111 ++i;
112 }
113 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
114 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000115 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000116 // skip over named parameters.
117 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
118 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
119 if (nullPos)
120 --nullPos;
121 else
122 ++i;
123 }
124 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000125 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000126 // block or function pointer call.
127 QualType Ty = V->getType();
128 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000129 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000130 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
131 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000132 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
133 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
134 unsigned k;
135 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
136 if (nullPos)
137 --nullPos;
138 else
139 ++i;
140 }
141 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
142 }
143 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
144 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000145 } else
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000146 return;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000147 } else
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000148 return;
149
150 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000151 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000152 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000153 return;
154 }
155 int sentinel = i;
156 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
157 --sentinelPos;
158 ++i;
159 }
160 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
161 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000162 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000163 return;
164 }
165 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
166 ++i;
167 ++sentinel;
168 }
169 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000170 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
171 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
172 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Fariborz Jahanian9ccd7252010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000173 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000174 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
175 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
176 return;
177
178 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
179 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
180
181 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
182 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000183}
184
Douglas Gregor4b2d3f72009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000185SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
186 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
187 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
188}
189
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000190//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
191// Standard Promotions and Conversions
192//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
193
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000194/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
195void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
196 QualType Ty = E->getType();
197 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
198
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000199 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000200 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000201 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000202 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
203 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
204 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
205 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
206 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
207 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
208 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc39a3d72008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000209 //
210 // C++ 4.2p1:
211 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
212 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
213 //
214 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
215 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson112a0a82009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000216 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000217 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000218 }
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000219}
220
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000221void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
222 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000223
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000224 QualType Ty = E->getType();
225 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
226 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
227 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
228 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
229 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
230 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
231 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
232 // rvalue is T
233 //
234 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000235 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
236 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000237 // type of the lvalue.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000238 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CK_NoOp);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000239 }
240}
241
242
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000243/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000244/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000245/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
246/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
247/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
248Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
249 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
250 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000251
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000252 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
253 //
254 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
255 // unsigned int may be used:
256 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
257 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
258 // and unsigned int.
259 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
260 //
261 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
262 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
263 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
264 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000265 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
266 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000267 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000268 return Expr;
269 }
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000270 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000271 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000272 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000273 return Expr;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000274 }
275
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000276 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000277 return Expr;
278}
279
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000280/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000281/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000282/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
283void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
284 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
285 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000286
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000287 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000288 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
289 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000290 CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000291
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000292 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
293}
294
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000295/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
296/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
297/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
298/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000299bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
300 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000301 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000302
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000303 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
304 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
305 // etc.
306 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
307 return false;
308
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000309 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000310 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
311 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
312 << Expr->getType() << CT))
313 return true;
Douglas Gregor75b699a2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000314
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000315 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000316 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000317 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
318 << Expr->getType() << CT))
319 return true;
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000320
321 return false;
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000322}
323
324
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000325/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
326/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000327/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000328/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
329/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
330/// GCC.
331QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
332 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000333 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000334 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000335
336 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000337
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000338 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000339 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000340 QualType lhs =
341 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000342 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000343 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000344
345 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
346 if (lhs == rhs)
347 return lhs;
348
349 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
350 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
351 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
352 return lhs;
353
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000354 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000355 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000356 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
357 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000358 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000359 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
360 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
361
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000362 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000363 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000364 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
365 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000366 return destType;
367}
368
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000369//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
370// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
371//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
372
373
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000374/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000375/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
376/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
377/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
378/// string.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000379///
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000380ExprResult
Sean Hunt6cf75022010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000381Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000382 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
383
Chris Lattnerbbee00b2009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000384 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000385 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000386 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000387
388 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
389 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
390 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000391
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000392 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis55f4b022008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000393 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000394 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000395
396 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattner7dc480f2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000397 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000398 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000399
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000400 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
401 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
402 // strings.
403 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerdbb1ecc2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000404 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000405 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000406
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000407 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Sean Hunt6cf75022010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000408 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
409 Literal.GetStringLength(),
410 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
411 &StringTokLocs[0],
412 StringTokLocs.size()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000413}
414
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000415/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
416/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
417/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
418/// for values inside the block or for globals).
419///
Douglas Gregor076ceb02010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000420/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000421/// up-to-date.
422///
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000423static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000424 ValueDecl *VD) {
425 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
426 // we wanted to.
427 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
428 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000429
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000430 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
431 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
432 return false;
433
434 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
435 // snapshot it.
436 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
437 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000438 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
439 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000440
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000441 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
442 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
443
444 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
445 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
446 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
447 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000448 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
449 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000450
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000451 if (!NextBlock)
452 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000453
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000454 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
455 // having a reference outside it.
456 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
457 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000458
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000459 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
460 // a snapshot as well.
461 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
462 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000463
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000464 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000465}
466
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000467
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000468ExprResult
John McCalldbd872f2009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000469Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000470 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000471 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
472 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, NameInfo, SS);
473}
474
475/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000476ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000477Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty,
478 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
479 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000480 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000481 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000482 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000483 << D->getDeclName();
484 return ExprError();
485 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000486
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000487 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000488 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
489 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
490 // visible.
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000491 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000492 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000493 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
494 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000495 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
496 diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000497 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000498 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000499 << D->getIdentifier();
500 return ExprError();
501 }
502 }
503 }
504 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000505
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000506 MarkDeclarationReferenced(NameInfo.getLoc(), D);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000507
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000508 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
509 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
510 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000511 D, NameInfo, Ty));
Douglas Gregor1a49af92009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000512}
513
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000514/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
515/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
516/// actual member.
517///
518/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
519/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
520/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
521/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
522/// we found.
523///
524/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
525/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
526/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
527VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
528 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000529 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
530 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
531 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
532
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000533 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000534 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
535 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
536 do {
537 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCallbc365c52010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000538 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000539 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000540 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000541 else {
542 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
543 break;
544 }
545 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000546 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000547 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000548
549 return BaseObject;
550}
551
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000552ExprResult
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000553Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
554 FieldDecl *Field,
555 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
556 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
557 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000558 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000559 AnonFields);
560
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000561 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
562 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
563 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
564 // found via name lookup.
565 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000566 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000567 if (BaseObject) {
568 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
569 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000570 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000571 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +0000572 SourceLocation());
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000573 BaseQuals
574 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000575 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
576 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
577 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
578 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
579 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000580 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000581 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
582 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
583 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000584 BaseQuals
585 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000586 } else {
587 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
588 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
589 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000590 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
591 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000592 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000593 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000594 = Context.getTagDeclType(
595 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
596 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000597 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000598 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
599 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
600 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor8aa5f402009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000601 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000602 MD->getThisType(Context),
603 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000604 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
605 }
606 } else {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000607 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
608 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000609 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000610 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000611 }
612
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000613 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000614 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
615 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000616 }
617
618 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
619 // anonymous struct/union.
620 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000621 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000622 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
623 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
624 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
625 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000626 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
627 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
628
629 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
630 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
631 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
632 ResultQuals.removeConst();
633
634 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
635 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
636
637 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
638 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
639
640 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
641 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
642 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
643
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000644 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000645 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000646 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000647 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
648 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000649 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000650 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000651 }
652
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000653 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000654}
655
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000656/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000657/// possibly a list of template arguments.
658///
659/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
660/// DecomposeTemplateName.
661///
662/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
663/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
664/// some way.
665static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
666 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
667 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000668 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000669 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
670 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
671 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
672 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
673
674 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
675 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
676 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
677 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
678 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
679
John McCall2b5289b2010-08-23 07:28:44 +0000680 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000681 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
682 NameInfo = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000683 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
684 } else {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000685 NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000686 TemplateArgs = 0;
687 }
688}
689
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000690/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
691/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
692/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000693static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000694 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
695 return false;
696
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000697 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
698 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
699 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
700 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
701 if (!BaseRT) return false;
702
703 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000704 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000705 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
706 return false;
707 }
708
709 return true;
710}
711
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000712/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
713/// the prospective base classes.
714static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
715 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
716 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000717 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000718 return false;
719
Douglas Gregor952b0172010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000720 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000721 if (!RD) return false;
722 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
723
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000724 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
725 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
726 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
727 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
728 if (!BaseRT) return false;
729
730 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000731 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
732 return false;
733 }
734
735 return true;
736}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000737
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000738enum IMAKind {
739 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
740 IMA_Static,
741
742 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
743 IMA_Mixed,
744
745 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
746 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
747 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
748
749 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
750 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
751 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
752
753 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
754 IMA_Instance,
755
756 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
757 IMA_Unresolved,
758
759 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
760 /// context is not an instance method.
761 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
762
763 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
764 /// non-class context.
765 IMA_AnonymousMember,
766
767 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
768 /// context is not an instance method.
769 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
770
771 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
772 /// class.
773 IMA_Error_Unrelated
774};
775
776/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
777/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
778/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
779/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
780/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
781/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
782static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
783 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000784 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000785
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000786 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000787 bool isStaticContext =
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000788 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
789 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000790
791 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
792 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
793
794 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
795 bool hasNonInstance = false;
796 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
797 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000798 NamedDecl *D = *I;
799 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000800 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
801
802 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
803 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
804 // that's a special case.
805 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
806 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
807 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
808 }
809 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
810 }
811 else
812 hasNonInstance = true;
813 }
814
815 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
816 // member reference.
817 if (Classes.empty())
818 return IMA_Static;
819
820 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
821 // an implicit member reference.
822 if (isStaticContext)
823 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
824
825 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
826 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
827 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
828 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000829 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000830 Classes))
831 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
832
833 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
834}
835
836/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
837static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
838 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
839 const LookupResult &R) {
840 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
841 SourceRange Range(Loc);
842 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
843
844 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
845 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
846 if (MD->isStatic()) {
847 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
848 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
849 << Range << R.getLookupName();
850 return;
851 }
852 }
853
854 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
855 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
856 return;
857 }
858
859 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000860}
861
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000862/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
863///
864/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000865bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
866 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000867 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
868
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000869 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000870 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000871 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
872 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000873 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000874 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000875 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
876 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000877
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000878 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
879 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
880 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
881 // dependent name.
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000882 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000883 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000884 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
885 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
886
887 if (!R.empty()) {
888 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
889 R.suppressDiagnostics();
890
891 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
892 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
893 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
894 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
895
896 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
897 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
898 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000899 if (isInstance) {
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000900 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
901 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000902 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000903 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000904 if (DepMethod) {
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000905 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
906 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
907 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
908 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(
909 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false);
910 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
911 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
912 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
913 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
914 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
915 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
916 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL,
917 R.getLookupNameInfo(), &TList);
918 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000919 } else {
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000920 // FIXME: we should be able to handle this case too. It is correct
921 // to add this-> here. This is a workaround for PR7947.
922 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000923 }
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000924 } else {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000925 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000926 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000927
928 // Do we really want to note all of these?
929 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
930 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
931
932 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
933 return false;
934 }
Douglas Gregore26f0432010-08-09 22:38:14 +0000935
936 R.clear();
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000937 }
938 }
939
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000940 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000941 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbardc32cdf2010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000942 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000943 if (!R.empty()) {
944 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
945 if (SS.isEmpty())
946 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
947 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
948 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
949 else
950 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
951 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
952 << SS.getRange()
953 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
954 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
955 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
956 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
957 << ND->getDeclName();
958
959 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
960 return false;
961 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000962
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000963 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
964 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
965 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
966 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
967 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
968 // to recover well anyway.
969 if (SS.isEmpty())
970 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
971 else
972 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
973 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
974 << SS.getRange();
975
976 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
977 return true;
978 }
979 } else {
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000980 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000981 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000982 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000983 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000984 else
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000985 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000986 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
987 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000988 return true;
989 }
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000990 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000991 }
992
993 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
994 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
995 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
996 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
997 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
998 << SS.getRange();
999 return true;
1000 }
1001
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001002 // Give up, we can't recover.
1003 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1004 return true;
1005}
1006
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001007static ObjCPropertyDecl *OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001008 IdentifierInfo *II,
1009 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001010 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
1011 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1012 if (!IDecl)
1013 return 0;
1014 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1015 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1016 return 0;
1017 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1018 if (!property)
1019 return 0;
1020 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1021 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
1022 return 0;
1023 return property;
1024}
1025
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001026static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001027 LookupResult &Lookup,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001028 IdentifierInfo *II,
1029 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1030 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001031 bool LookForIvars;
1032 if (Lookup.empty())
1033 LookForIvars = true;
1034 else if (CurMeth->isClassMethod())
1035 LookForIvars = false;
1036 else
1037 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1038 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
1039 if (!LookForIvars)
1040 return 0;
1041
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001042 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1043 if (!IDecl)
1044 return 0;
1045 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian84ef4b22010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001046 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1047 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001048 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1049 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1050 if (!property)
1051 return 0;
1052 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1053 DynamicImplSeen =
1054 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
1055 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian84ef4b22010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001056 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1057 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001058 NameLoc,
1059 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1060 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1061 (Expr *)0, true);
1062 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1063 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1064 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1065 return Ivar;
1066 }
1067 return 0;
1068}
1069
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001070ExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
John McCallfb97e752010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001071 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1072 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1073 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1074 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001075 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1076 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1077
1078 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor4c921ae2009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001079 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001080
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001081 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001082
1083 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001084 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001085 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001086 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001087
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001088 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
Douglas Gregor10c42622008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001089 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001090 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001091
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001092 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1093 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregor48026d22010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001094 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1095 // (note: handled after lookup)
1096 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1097 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1098 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001099 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1100 // names a dependent type.
1101 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1102 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman647c8b32010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001103 bool DependentID = false;
1104 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1105 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1106 DependentID = true;
1107 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
1108 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1109 if (DC) {
1110 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1111 return ExprError();
1112 // FIXME: We should be checking whether DC is the current instantiation.
1113 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
1114 DependentID = !IsFullyFormedScope(*this, RD);
1115 } else {
1116 DependentID = true;
1117 }
1118 }
1119
1120 if (DependentID) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001121 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, isAddressOfOperand,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001122 TemplateArgs);
1123 }
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001124 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001125 // Perform the required lookup.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001126 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001127 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregord2235f62010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001128 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1129 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1130 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1131 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1132 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor1fd6d442010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001133 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1134 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1135 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001136 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001137 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001138 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001139
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001140 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1141 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001142 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001143 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001144 if (E.isInvalid())
1145 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001146
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001147 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1148 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001149 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1150 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001151 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, R, II, NameLoc))
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001152 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1153 isAddressOfOperand);
1154 }
Fariborz Jahanianf759b4d2010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001155 // for further use, this must be set to false if in class method.
1156 IvarLookupFollowUp = getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod();
Steve Naroffe3e9add2008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001157 }
Chris Lattner8a934232008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001158 }
Douglas Gregorc71e28c2009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001159
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001160 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1161 return ExprError();
1162
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001163 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1164 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001165 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001166
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001167 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001168 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001169 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1170 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1171 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1172 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1173 }
1174
1175 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1176 // call, diagnose the problem.
1177 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor91f7ac72010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001178 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001179 return ExprError();
1180
1181 assert(!R.empty() &&
1182 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001183
1184 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1185 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001186 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001187 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1188 R.clear();
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001189 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001190 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1191 return move(E);
1192 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001193 }
1194 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001195
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001196 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1197 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1198
1199 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001200 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
Fariborz Jahanianb1d58e32010-07-29 16:53:53 +00001201 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2 &&
1202 Var->isFileVarDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001203 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property =
1204 OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, II, NameLoc);
1205 if (Property) {
1206 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1207 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
Fariborz Jahanianf759b4d2010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001208 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_global_declared_at);
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001209 }
1210 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001211 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001212 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1213 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1214 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1215 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1216 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1217 // type.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001218 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001219 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001220
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001221 QualType T = Func->getType();
1222 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001223 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedman9a0fcfe2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001224 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1225 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001226 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001227 }
1228 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001229
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001230 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
John McCallfb97e752010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001231 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
1232 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
1233 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
1234 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
1235 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
1236 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
1237 // class member access expression using (*this) as the
1238 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001239 //
1240 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R
1241 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the
1242 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a
1243 // non-static member function:
1244 //
1245 // C++ [expr.ref]p4:
1246 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . .
1247 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a
1248 // member function call.
1249 //
1250 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important
1251 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a
1252 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent
1253 // instance method.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001254 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001255 bool MightBeImplicitMember;
1256 if (!isAddressOfOperand)
1257 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
1258 else if (!SS.isEmpty())
1259 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
1260 else if (R.isOverloadedResult())
1261 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
Douglas Gregore2248be2010-08-30 16:00:47 +00001262 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
1263 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001264 else
1265 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
1266
1267 if (MightBeImplicitMember)
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001268 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001269 }
1270
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001271 if (TemplateArgs)
1272 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001273
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001274 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1275}
1276
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001277/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001278ExprResult
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001279Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1280 LookupResult &R,
1281 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1282 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1283 case IMA_Instance:
1284 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1285
1286 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1287 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1288 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1289 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1290
1291 case IMA_Mixed:
1292 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1293 case IMA_Unresolved:
1294 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1295
1296 case IMA_Static:
1297 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1298 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1299 if (TemplateArgs)
1300 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1301 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1302
1303 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1304 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1305 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1306 return ExprError();
1307 }
1308
1309 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1310 return ExprError();
1311}
1312
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001313/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1314/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1315/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1316/// this path.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001317ExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001318Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001319 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001320 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001321 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001322 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, NameInfo, 0);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001323
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001324 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001325 return ExprError();
1326
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001327 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001328 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1329
1330 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1331 return ExprError();
1332
1333 if (R.empty()) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001334 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1335 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001336 return ExprError();
1337 }
1338
1339 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1340}
1341
1342/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1343/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1344/// additional lookup.
1345///
1346/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1347/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1348///
1349/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001350ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001351Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnereb483eb2010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001352 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001353 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001354 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001355
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001356 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1357 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1358 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1359 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1360 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1361
1362 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1363 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1364 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001365 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001366
1367 bool LookForIvars;
1368 if (Lookup.empty())
1369 LookForIvars = true;
1370 else if (IsClassMethod)
1371 LookForIvars = false;
1372 else
1373 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1374 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian412e7982010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001375 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001376 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001377 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001378 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1379 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1380 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1381 if (IsClassMethod)
1382 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1383 << IV->getDeclName());
1384
1385 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1386 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1387 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1388 return ExprError();
1389
1390 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1391 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1392 return ExprError();
1393
1394 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1395 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1396 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1397 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1398
1399 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1400 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1401 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1402 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001403 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001404 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001405 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
Douglas Gregore45bb6a2010-09-22 16:33:13 +00001406 SelfName, false, false);
1407 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid())
1408 return ExprError();
1409
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001410 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1411 return Owned(new (Context)
1412 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1413 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1414 }
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001415 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001416 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001417 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001418 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1419 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1420 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1421 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1422 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1423 }
1424 }
1425
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001426 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1427 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1428 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1429 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1430 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1431 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1432 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1433 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1434 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1435 }
1436 }
1437 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001438 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1439 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001440}
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001441
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001442/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1443///
1444/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1445///
1446/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1447/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1448/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1449/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1450///
1451/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1452/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1453/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1454/// the class declaring the member.
1455///
1456/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1457/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1458/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001459bool
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001460Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1461 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001462 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001463 NamedDecl *Member) {
1464 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1465 if (!RD)
1466 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001467
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001468 QualType DestRecordType;
1469 QualType DestType;
1470 QualType FromRecordType;
1471 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1472 bool PointerConversions = false;
1473 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1474 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001475
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001476 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1477 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1478 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1479 PointerConversions = true;
1480 } else {
1481 DestType = DestRecordType;
1482 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001483 }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001484 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1485 if (Method->isStatic())
1486 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001487
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001488 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1489 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001490
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001491 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1492 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1493 PointerConversions = true;
1494 } else {
1495 FromRecordType = FromType;
1496 DestType = DestRecordType;
1497 }
1498 } else {
1499 // No conversion necessary.
1500 return false;
1501 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001502
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001503 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1504 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001505
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001506 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1507 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1508 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001509
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001510 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1511 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1512
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001513 ExprValueKind VK = CastCategory(From);
Sebastian Redl906082e2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001514
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001515 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001516 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001517 // class name.
1518 //
1519 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1520 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1521 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1522 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1523 //
1524 // class Base { public: int x; };
1525 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1526 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1527 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1528 //
1529 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1530 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1531 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1532 // }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001533 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001534 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1535 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1536 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1537
1538 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1539
1540 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1541 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1542 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1543 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001544 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001545 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001546 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001547 return true;
1548
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001549 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001550 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001551 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
1552 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001553
1554 FromType = QType;
1555 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1556
1557 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1558 // we're done.
1559 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1560 return false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001561 }
1562 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001563
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001564 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001565
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001566 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1567 // down to the using declaration's type.
1568 //
1569 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1570 // class ever has member declarations.
1571 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1572 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1573 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1574 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1575
1576 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1577 // conversion is non-trivial.
1578 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1579 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001580 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001581 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001582 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001583 return true;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001584
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001585 QualType UType = URecordType;
1586 if (PointerConversions)
1587 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001588 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001589 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001590 FromType = UType;
1591 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1592 }
1593
1594 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1595 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1596 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001597 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001598
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001599 CXXCastPath BasePath;
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001600 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1601 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001602 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001603 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001604
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001605 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001606 VK, &BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001607 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001608}
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001609
Douglas Gregor83f6faf2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001610/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001611static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedmanf595cc42009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001612 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001613 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001614 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo,
1615 QualType Ty,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001616 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1617 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1618 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001619 if (SS.isSet()) {
1620 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1621 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001622 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001623
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001624 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001625 Member, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
1626 TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001627}
1628
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001629/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1630/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1631/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1632/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001633ExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001634Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1635 LookupResult &R,
1636 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1637 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001638 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1639
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001640 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001641
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001642 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1643 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregore961afb2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001644 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001645 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001646 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001647 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001648 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001649
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001650 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1651 // 'this' expression now.
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001652 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1653 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001654 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1655 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001656 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1657 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1658 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1659 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001660 }
1661
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001662 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(This, ThisType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001663 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1664 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001665 SS,
1666 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1667 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001668}
1669
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001670bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001671 const LookupResult &R,
1672 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001673 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1674 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1675 return false;
1676
1677 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001678 if (SS.isSet())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001679 return false;
1680
1681 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001682 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001683 return false;
1684
1685 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1686 // normal lookup:
1687 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1688 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1689
1690 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1691 // -- a declaration of a class member
1692 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1693 // original decl.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001694 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001695 return false;
1696
1697 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1698 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1699 // using-declaration
1700 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1701 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1702 // turn off ADL anyway).
1703 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1704 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1705 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1706 return false;
1707
1708 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1709 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1710 // template
1711 // And also for builtin functions.
1712 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1713 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1714
1715 // But also builtin functions.
1716 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1717 return false;
1718 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1719 return false;
1720 }
1721
1722 return true;
1723}
1724
1725
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001726/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1727/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1728/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1729/// will in fact be used.
1730static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1731 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1732 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1733 return true;
1734 }
1735
1736 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1737 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1738 return true;
1739 }
1740
1741 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1742 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1743 return true;
1744 }
1745
1746 return false;
1747}
1748
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001749ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001750Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001751 LookupResult &R,
1752 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCallfead20c2009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001753 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1754 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor86b8e092010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001755 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001756 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(),
1757 R.getFoundDecl());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001758
1759 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1760 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1761 // functions and function templates.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001762 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1763 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001764 return ExprError();
1765
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001766 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1767 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1768 // we've picked a target.
1769 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1770
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001771 bool Dependent
1772 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001773 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001774 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001775 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001776 SS.getRange(), R.getLookupNameInfo(),
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001777 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1778 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001779
1780 return Owned(ULE);
1781}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001782
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001783
1784/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001785ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001786Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001787 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1788 NamedDecl *D) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001789 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall7453ed42009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001790 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1791 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001792
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001793 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001794 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1795 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001796
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001797 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1798 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1799 // a template argument list.
1800 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1801 << Template << SS.getRange();
1802 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1803 return ExprError();
1804 }
1805
1806 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1807 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1808 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001809 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001810 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCall87cf6702009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001811 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001812 return ExprError();
1813 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001814
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001815 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1816 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1817 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1818 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001819 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001820 return ExprError();
1821
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001822 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1823 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001824 return ExprError();
1825
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001826 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1827 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1828 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1829 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001830 //
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001831 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1832 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1833 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001834 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001835 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump0d6fd572010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001836 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1837 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1838 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1839 return ExprError();
1840 }
1841
Fariborz Jahanian8596bbe2010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001842 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump28497342010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001843 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1844 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1845 return ExprError();
1846 }
1847
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001848 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001849 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001850 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001851 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001852 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001853 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1854 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001855 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001856
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001857 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian52bc56a2010-07-12 17:26:57 +00001858 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001859 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1860 ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanian84ca0082010-07-12 18:12:03 +00001861 constAdded);
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001862 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1863 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
1864 Expr *E = new (Context)
1865 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1866 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001867
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001868 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001869 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian310b1c42010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001870 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001871 SourceLocation(),
1872 Owned(E));
1873 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001874 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(Res.get());
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001875 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
1876 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
1877 }
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001878 }
1879 }
1880 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001881 }
1882 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1883 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001884
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001885 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
1886 NameInfo, &SS);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001887}
1888
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001889ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001890 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001891 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001892
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001893 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001894 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001895 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1896 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1897 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001898 }
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001899
Chris Lattnerfa28b302008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001900 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1901 // string.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001902
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001903 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanianeb024ac2010-07-23 21:53:24 +00001904 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
1905 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001906 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001907 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001908 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001909 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001910
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001911 QualType ResTy;
1912 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1913 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1914 } else {
Anders Carlsson848fa642010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001915 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001916
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001917 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001918 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001919 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1920 }
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001921 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001922}
1923
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001924ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001925 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001926 bool Invalid = false;
1927 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1928 if (Invalid)
1929 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001930
Benjamin Kramerddeea562010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001931 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1932 PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001933 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001934 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001935
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001936 QualType Ty;
1937 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1938 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1939 else if (Literal.isWide())
1940 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedman136b0cd2010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001941 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1942 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001943 else
1944 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001945
Sebastian Redle91b3bc2009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001946 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1947 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001948 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001949}
1950
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001951ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001952 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001953 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1954 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner7216dc92009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001955 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattner0c21e842009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001956 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00001957 return Owned(IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff0a473932009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001958 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001959 }
Ted Kremenek28396602009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001960
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001961 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattner2a299042008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001962 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1963 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001964 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001965
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001966 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001967 bool Invalid = false;
1968 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1969 if (Invalid)
1970 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001971
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001972 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001973 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
1974 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001975 return ExprError();
1976
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001977 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001978
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001979 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001980 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001981 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001982 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001983 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001984 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001985 else
Chris Lattner9e9b6dc2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001986 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001987
1988 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1989
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001990 using llvm::APFloat;
1991 APFloat Val(Format);
1992
1993 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall9f2df882009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001994
1995 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1996 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1997 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1998 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001999 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002000 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002001 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002002 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002003 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
2004 } else {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002005 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002006 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
2007 }
2008
2009 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
2010 << Ty
2011 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
2012 }
2013
2014 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002015 Res = FloatingLiteral::Create(Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002016
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002017 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002018 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002019 } else {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002020 QualType Ty;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002021
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002022 // long long is a C99 feature.
2023 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth79859c32007-08-29 22:13:52 +00002024 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002025 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
2026
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002027 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002028 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002029
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002030 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
2031 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
2032 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002033 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
2034 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002035 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002036 } else {
2037 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
2038 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002039
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002040 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
2041 // be an unsigned int.
2042 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
2043
2044 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002045 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner97c51562007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002046 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2047 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002048 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002049
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002050 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2051 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2052 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2053 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002054 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002055 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002056 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002057 Width = IntSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002058 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002059 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002060
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002061 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002062 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002063 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002064
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002065 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2066 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2067 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2068 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002069 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002070 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002071 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002072 Width = LongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002073 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002074 }
2075
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002076 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002077 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002078 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002079
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002080 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2081 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2082 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2083 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002084 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002085 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002086 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002087 Width = LongLongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002088 }
2089 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002090
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002091 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2092 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002093 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002094 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002095 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002096 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002097 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002098
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002099 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2100 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002101 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002102 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002103 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002104
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002105 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2106 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002107 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002108 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002109
2110 return Owned(Res);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002111}
2112
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002113ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002114 SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002115 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002116 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002117}
2118
2119/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
2120/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002121bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002122 SourceLocation OpLoc,
2123 const SourceRange &ExprRange,
2124 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002125 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2126 return false;
2127
Sebastian Redl5d484e82009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002128 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2129 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2130 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2131 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2132 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2133 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2134
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002135 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002136 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002137 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002138 if (isSizeof)
2139 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2140 return false;
2141 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002142
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002143 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002144 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002145 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2146 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002147 return false;
2148 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002149
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002150 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002151 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2152 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002153 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002154
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002155 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002156 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002157 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattner5cb10d32009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002158 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2159 return true;
Chris Lattnerca790922009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002160 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002161
Douglas Gregor9ba6af82010-05-23 19:43:23 +00002162 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(exprType, Context.OverloadTy)) {
2163 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_overloaded_function_type)
2164 << !isSizeof << ExprRange;
2165 return true;
2166 }
2167
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002168 return false;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002169}
2170
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002171bool Sema::CheckAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2172 const SourceRange &ExprRange) {
2173 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002174
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002175 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002176 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2177 return false;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002178
2179 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2180 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2181 return false;
2182
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002183 if (E->getBitField()) {
2184 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
2185 return true;
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002186 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002187
2188 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2189 // bit-field.
2190 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump8e1fab22009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002191 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002192 return false;
2193
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002194 return CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
2195}
2196
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002197/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002198ExprResult
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002199Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002200 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002201 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002202 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002203 return ExprError();
2204
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002205 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002206
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002207 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2208 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2209 return ExprError();
2210
2211 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002212 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002213 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2214 R.getEnd()));
2215}
2216
2217/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2218/// operand.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002219ExprResult
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002220Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002221 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2222 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2223 bool isInvalid = false;
2224 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2225 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2226 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
2227 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002228 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002229 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2230 isInvalid = true;
2231 } else {
2232 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2233 }
2234
2235 if (isInvalid)
2236 return ExprError();
2237
2238 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2239 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2240 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2241 R.getEnd()));
2242}
2243
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002244/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2245/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2246/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002247ExprResult
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002248Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2249 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002250 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002251 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002252
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002253 if (isType) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002254 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00002255 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002256 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002257 }
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002258
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002259 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002260 ExprResult Result
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002261 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2262
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002263 return move(Result);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002264}
2265
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002266QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002267 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2268 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002269
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002270 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002271 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002272 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002273
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002274 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2275 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2276 return V->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002277
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002278 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002279 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2280 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002281 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002282}
2283
2284
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002285
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002286ExprResult
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002287Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002288 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002289 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002290 switch (Kind) {
2291 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002292 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
2293 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002294 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002295
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002296 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002297}
2298
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002299ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002300Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2301 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002302 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002303 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002304 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2305 Base = Result.take();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002306
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002307 Expr *LHSExp = Base, *RHSExp = Idx;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002308
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002309 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002310 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002311 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2312 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2313 }
2314
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002315 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002316 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman03f332a2008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002317 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2318 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2319 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002320 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, Base, Idx);
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002321 }
2322
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002323 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Base, LLoc, Idx, RLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002324}
2325
2326
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002327ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002328Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2329 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2330 Expr *LHSExp = Base;
2331 Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002332
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002333 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002334 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2335 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2336 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002337
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002338 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002339
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002340 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002341 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002342 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002343 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002344 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2345 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002346 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2347 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2348 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2349 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002350 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002351 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2352 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002353 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002354 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner7a2e0472007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002355 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002356 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2357 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002358 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002359 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002360 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002361 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2362 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2363 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002364 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002365 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002366 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2367 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2368 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2369 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002370 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattnerc8629632007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002371 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002372 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begeman334a8022009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002373
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002374 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2375 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002376 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2377 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002378 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002379 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2380 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2381 // force the promotion here.
2382 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2383 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002384 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002385 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002386 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2387
2388 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2389 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002390 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002391 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2392 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2393 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2394 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002395 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002396 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002397 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2398
2399 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2400 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002401 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002402 } else {
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002403 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2404 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002405 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002406 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002407 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002408 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2409 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002410
Daniel Dunbar7e88a602009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002411 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinig0f9a5b52009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002412 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2413 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig76e2b712009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002414 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2415
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002416 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002417 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2418 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002419 // incomplete types are not object types.
2420 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2421 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2422 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2423 return ExprError();
2424 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002425
Abramo Bagnara46358452010-09-13 06:50:07 +00002426 if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
2427 // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void
2428 Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
2429 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2430 } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002431 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002432 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2433 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002434 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002435
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002436 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002437 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002438 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2439 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2440 return ExprError();
2441 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002442
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002443 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002444 ResultType, RLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002445}
2446
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002447QualType Sema::
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002448CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002449 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002450 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbar2ad32892009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002451 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2452 // see FIXME there.
2453 //
2454 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2455 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002456 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002457
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002458 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002459 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002460
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002461 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002462 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2463 // to be selected.
2464 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002465
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002466 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2467 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman131f4652009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002468 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002469
2470 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2471 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002472 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002473 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2474 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002475 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002476 do
2477 compStr++;
2478 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002479 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002480 do
2481 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002482 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002483 }
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002484
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002485 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002486 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2487 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002488 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
Benjamin Kramer476d8b82010-08-11 14:47:12 +00002489 << llvm::StringRef(compStr, 1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002490 return QualType();
2491 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002492
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002493 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2494 // operates on.
2495 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002496 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002497
2498 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002499 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002500
2501 while (*compStr) {
2502 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2503 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2504 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2505 return QualType();
2506 }
2507 }
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002508 }
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002509
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002510 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002511 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002512 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002513 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002514 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begeman0479a0b2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002515 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002516 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002517 if (HexSwizzle)
2518 CompSize--;
2519
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002520 if (CompSize == 1)
2521 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002522
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002523 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002524 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002525 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2526 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2527 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2528 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffbea0b342007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002529 }
2530 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002531}
2532
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002533static Decl *FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002534 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002535 const Selector &Sel,
2536 ASTContext &Context) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002537
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002538 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002539 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002540 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002541 return OMD;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002542
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002543 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2544 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002545 if (Decl *D = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002546 Context))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002547 return D;
2548 }
2549 return 0;
2550}
2551
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002552static Decl *FindGetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002553 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002554 const Selector &Sel,
2555 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002556 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2557 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002558 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002559 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002560 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002561 GDecl = PD;
2562 break;
2563 }
2564 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002565 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002566 GDecl = OMD;
2567 break;
2568 }
2569 }
2570 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002571 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002572 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2573 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002574 GDecl = FindGetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel, Context);
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002575 if (GDecl)
2576 return GDecl;
2577 }
2578 }
2579 return GDecl;
2580}
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002581
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002582ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002583Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002584 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002585 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2586 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002587 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002588 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002589 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2590 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2591 //
2592 // T* t;
2593 // t.f;
2594 //
2595 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2596 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2597 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2598 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002599 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002600 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2601 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002602 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002603 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002604 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002605 return ExprError();
2606 }
2607 }
2608
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002609 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2610 NameInfo.getName().isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002611 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002612
2613 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2614 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002615 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002616 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002617 SS.getScopeRep(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002618 SS.getRange(),
2619 FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002620 NameInfo, TemplateArgs));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002621}
2622
2623/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2624/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2625/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2626static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2627 Expr *BaseExpr,
2628 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002629 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002630 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002631 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2632 // diagnostics.
2633 if (!BaseExpr)
2634 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002635
John McCall110acc12010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002636 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2637 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002638}
2639
2640// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2641// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2642// type. The restriction here is:
2643//
2644// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2645// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2646// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2647//
2648// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2649// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2650// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2651// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2652bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2653 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002654 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002655 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002656 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2657 if (!BaseRT) {
2658 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2659 // dependent.
2660 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2661 return false;
2662 }
2663 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002664
2665 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002666 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2667 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002668 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002669 return false;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002670
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002671 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman02463762010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002672 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
2673 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
2674 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002675
Douglas Gregor9d4bb942010-07-28 22:27:52 +00002676 if (!DC->isRecord())
2677 continue;
2678
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002679 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman02463762010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002680 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002681
2682 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2683 return false;
2684 }
2685
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002686 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002687 return true;
2688}
2689
2690static bool
2691LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2692 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002693 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2694 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002695 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2696 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002697 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002698 << BaseRange))
2699 return true;
2700
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002701 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2702 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2703 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2704
2705 bool MOUS;
2706 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2707 return false;
2708 }
2709
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002710 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2711 if (SS.isSet()) {
2712 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2713 // nested-name-specifier.
2714 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2715
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002716 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002717 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2718 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2719 return true;
2720 }
2721
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002722 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002723
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002724 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2725 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2726 << DC << SS.getRange();
2727 return true;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002728 }
2729 }
2730
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002731 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2732 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002733
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002734 if (!R.empty())
2735 return false;
2736
2737 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2738 // for typos.
2739 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002740 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002741 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002742 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2743 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2744 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002745 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2746 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002747 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2748 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2749 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002750 return false;
2751 } else {
2752 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002753 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002754 }
2755
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002756 return false;
2757}
2758
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002759ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002760Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *Base, QualType BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002761 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002762 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002763 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002764 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002765 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002766 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2767 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002768 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002769 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2770 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002771 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002772
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002773 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002774
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002775 // Implicit member accesses.
2776 if (!Base) {
2777 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2778 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2779 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2780 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002781 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002782 return ExprError();
2783
2784 // Explicit member accesses.
2785 } else {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002786 ExprResult Result =
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002787 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00002788 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ 0, TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002789
2790 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2791 Owned(Base);
2792 return ExprError();
2793 }
2794
2795 if (Result.get())
2796 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlf3e63372010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002797
2798 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2799 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002800 }
2801
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002802 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002803 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2804 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002805}
2806
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002807ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002808Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseExprType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002809 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2810 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002811 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002812 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002813 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2814 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002815 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002816 if (IsArrow) {
2817 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2818 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2819 }
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002820 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002821
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002822 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = SS.getScopeRep();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002823 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo = R.getLookupNameInfo();
2824 DeclarationName MemberName = MemberNameInfo.getName();
2825 SourceLocation MemberLoc = MemberNameInfo.getLoc();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002826
2827 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002828 return ExprError();
2829
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002830 if (R.empty()) {
2831 // Rederive where we looked up.
2832 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2833 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2834 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002835
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002836 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002837 << MemberName << DC
2838 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002839 return ExprError();
2840 }
2841
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002842 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2843 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2844 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2845 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2846 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2847 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2848 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2849 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2850 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2851 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002852 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002853 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002854 return ExprError();
2855
2856 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2857 // result.
2858 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002859 bool Dependent =
John McCall410a3f32009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002860 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002861 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002862 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002863
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002864 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2865 // pick a member.
2866 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2867
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002868 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2869 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2870 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002871 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2872 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002873 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002874 MemberNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002875 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002876
2877 return Owned(MemExpr);
2878 }
2879
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002880 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002881 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002882 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2883
2884 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2885
2886 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2887 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2888 // error cases.
2889 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2890 return ExprError();
2891
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002892 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2893 if (!BaseExpr) {
2894 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002895 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002896 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), MemberDecl);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002897
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002898 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2899 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2900 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2901 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002902 }
2903
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002904 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2905 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2906 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2907 // explicitly qualified.
2908 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2909 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2910 }
2911
2912 // Check the use of this member.
2913 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2914 Owned(BaseExpr);
2915 return ExprError();
2916 }
2917
2918 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2919 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2920 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman16c53782009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002921 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2922 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002923 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2924 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2925
2926 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2927 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2928 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2929 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2930 else {
2931 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2932 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2933 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2934
2935 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2936 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2937
2938 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2939 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2940 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2941 }
2942
2943 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002944 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002945 return ExprError();
2946 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002947 FD, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2948 MemberType));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002949 }
2950
2951 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2952 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2953 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002954 Var, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002955 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2956 }
2957
2958 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2959 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2960 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002961 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002962 MemberFn->getType()));
2963 }
2964
2965 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2966 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2967 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002968 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2969 Enum->getType()));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002970 }
2971
2972 Owned(BaseExpr);
2973
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002974 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002975 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002976 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002977 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2978 else
2979 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2980 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002981
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002982 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2983 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002984 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002985 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002986}
2987
2988/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2989/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2990/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
2991/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
2992/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
2993/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
2994/// an ordinary member expression.
2995///
2996/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
2997/// fixed for ObjC++.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002998ExprResult
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002999Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003000 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003001 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003002 Decl *ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003003 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003004
Steve Naroff3cc4af82007-12-16 21:42:28 +00003005 // Perform default conversions.
3006 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003007
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003008 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003009 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
3010
3011 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
3012 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003013
3014 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003015 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003016 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
3017 // call, and continue on.
3018 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3019 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
3020 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
3021 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
3022 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003023 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
3024 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003025 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
3026 ->isRecordType()))) {
3027 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
3028 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
3029 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003030 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003031
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003032 ExprResult NewBase
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003033 = ActOnCallExpr(0, BaseExpr, Loc, MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), Loc);
Douglas Gregorf918b832010-06-21 22:46:46 +00003034 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003035 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003036 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003037
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003038 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
3039 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
3040 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
3041 }
3042 }
3043 }
3044
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003045 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3046 // use that.
3047 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003048 if (IsArrow) {
3049 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3050 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3051 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003052 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003053 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003054 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3055 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003056 }
3057 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003058 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3059 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3060 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3061 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003062 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003063 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003064 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003065
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003066 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3067 // use that.
3068 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3069 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3070 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3071 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3072 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003073 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003074 }
3075 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003076
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003077 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003078
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003079 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003080 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003081 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3082 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3083 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3084 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3085 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3086 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3087 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3088 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3089 // Check the use of this method.
3090 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3091 return ExprError();
3092 }
3093 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3094 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3095 Selector SetterSel =
3096 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3097 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3098 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3099 if (!Setter) {
3100 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3101 // methods.
Steve Naroffd789d3d2009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003102 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003103 }
3104 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3105 if (!Setter)
3106 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003107
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003108 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3109 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003110
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003111 if (Getter || Setter) {
3112 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003113
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003114 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003115 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003116 else
3117 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3118 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3119 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003120 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003121 PType,
3122 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3123 }
3124 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3125 << MemberName << BaseType);
3126 }
3127 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003128
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003129 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3130 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3131 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003132 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003133 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003134
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003135 if (IsArrow) {
3136 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003137 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003138 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3139 ;
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003140 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3141 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3142 // struct MyRecord foo;
3143 // foo->bar
3144 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3145 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3146 // by now.
3147 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3148 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003149 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003150 IsArrow = false;
3151 } else {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003152 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3153 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3154 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson4ef27702009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003155 }
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003156 } else {
3157 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3158 // type *foo;
3159 // foo.bar
3160 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3161 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3162 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3163 // the appropriate pointer type
3164 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3165 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3166 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3167 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3168 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003169 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003170 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3171 IsArrow = true;
3172 }
3173 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003174 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003175
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003176 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003177 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003178 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003179 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003180 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003181 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003182 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003183
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003184 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3185 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003186 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003187 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003188 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003189 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3190 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3191 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3192 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003193 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3194
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003195 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003196 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003197
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003198 if (!IV) {
3199 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3200 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3201 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003202 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003203 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003204 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003205 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3206 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003207 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3208 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003209 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003210 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003211 } else {
3212 Res.clear();
3213 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003214 }
3215 }
3216
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003217 if (IV) {
3218 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3219 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3220 // error cases.
3221 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3222 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003223
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003224 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3225 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3226 return ExprError();
3227 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3228 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3229 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3230 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3231 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3232 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3233 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3234 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3235 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3236 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3237 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3238 // AST for a function decl.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003239 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003240 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003241 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3242 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003243 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003244 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3245 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003246
3247 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3248 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003249 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003250 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003251 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003252 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3253 // @protected
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003254 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003255 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffb06d8752009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003256 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003257
3258 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3259 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003260 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahanian935fd762009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003261 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003262 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003263 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003264 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianaaa63a72008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003265 }
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003266 }
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003267 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003268 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3269 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003270 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003271 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003272
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003273 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003274 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003275 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel, Context)) {
3276 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3277 // Check the use of this declaration
3278 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3279 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003280
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003281 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3282 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3283 }
3284 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3285 // Check the use of this method.
3286 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3287 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003288
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003289 return Owned(ObjCMessageExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003290 OMD->getSendResultType(),
Douglas Gregor04badcf2010-04-21 00:45:42 +00003291 OpLoc, BaseExpr, Sel,
3292 OMD, NULL, 0, MemberLoc));
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003293 }
3294 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003295
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003296 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003297 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003298 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003299
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003300 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3301 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner7f816522010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003302 if (!IsArrow)
3303 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3304 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattnerb9d4fc12010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003305 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003306
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003307 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003308 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003309 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3310 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003311 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003312 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003313 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003314
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003315 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner73525de2009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003316 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003317 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003318 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3319 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003320 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003321 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003322 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003323 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003324
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003325 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3326 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3327
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003328 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003329}
3330
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003331/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3332/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3333/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3334/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3335/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3336///
3337/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3338/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3339/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3340/// only be called
3341/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3342/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3343/// aren't properly put in the context chain
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003344ExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003345 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3346 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003347 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003348 UnqualifiedId &Id,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003349 Decl *ObjCImpDecl,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003350 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3351 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3352 return ExprError();
3353
3354 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3355
3356 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003357 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003358 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3359 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003360 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003361
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003362 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003363 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3364
3365 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3366 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3367 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3368
3369 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003370 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003371 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3372 Base = Result.take();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003373
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003374 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3375 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003376 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003377 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3378 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003379 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003380 } else {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003381 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003382 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3383 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003384
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003385 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3386 Owned(Base);
3387 return ExprError();
3388 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003389
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003390 if (Result.get()) {
3391 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3392 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3393 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3394 // call now.
3395 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3396 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003397 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameInfo.getLoc(), Result.get());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003398
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003399 return move(Result);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003400 }
3401
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003402 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003403 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3404 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003405 }
3406
3407 return move(Result);
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003408}
3409
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003410ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003411 FunctionDecl *FD,
3412 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3413 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003414 Diag(CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003415 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3416 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003417 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003418 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003419 return ExprError();
3420 }
3421
3422 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3423 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003424
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003425 // Instantiate the expression.
3426 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3427 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson25cae7f2009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003428
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003429 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3430 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3431 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3432 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003433
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003434 ExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
3435 if (Result.isInvalid())
3436 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003437
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003438 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3439 InitializedEntity Entity
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003440 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003441 InitializationKind Kind
3442 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3443 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3444 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003445
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003446 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
3447 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3448 MultiExprArg(*this, &ResultE, 1));
3449 if (Result.isInvalid())
3450 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003451
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003452 // Build the default argument expression.
3453 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
3454 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003455 }
3456
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003457 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3458 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3459 // be properly destroyed.
3460 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3461 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Douglas Gregor5833b0b2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00003462 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i) {
3463 CXXTemporary *Temporary = Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i);
3464 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Param->getDefaultArg()->getLocStart(),
3465 const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl*>(Temporary->getDestructor()));
3466 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Temporary);
3467 }
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003468
3469 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00003470 // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression
3471 // as being "referenced".
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003472 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg());
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003473 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003474}
3475
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003476/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3477/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3478/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3479/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3480/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3481/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003482bool
3483Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003484 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003485 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003486 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3487 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003488 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003489 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3490 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003491 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003492
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003493 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3494 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3495 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3496 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3497 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003498 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherd77b9a22010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003499 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003500 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003501 }
3502
3503 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3504 // them.
3505 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3506 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3507 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3508 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003509 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherccfa9632010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003510 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003511 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3512 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3513 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003514 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003515 return true;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003516 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003517 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003518 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003519 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003520 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3521 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3522 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3523 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3524 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003525 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian2fe168f2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003526 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003527 if (Invalid)
3528 return true;
3529 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3530 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3531 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003532
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003533 return false;
3534}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003535
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003536bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3537 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3538 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3539 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3540 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3541 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003542 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003543 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3544 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3545 bool Invalid = false;
3546 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3547 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3548 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3549 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003550 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003551 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003552 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003553
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003554 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003555 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3556 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003557
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003558 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3559 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003560 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003561 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003562 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003563
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003564 // Pass the argument
3565 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3566 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3567 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregoraa037312009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003568
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003569 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003570 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param)
3571 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, ProtoArgType);
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003572 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003573 SourceLocation(),
3574 Owned(Arg));
3575 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3576 return true;
3577
3578 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003579 } else {
Anders Carlssoned961f92009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003580 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003581
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003582 ExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003583 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003584 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3585 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003586
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003587 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003588 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003589 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003590 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003591
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003592 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003593 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003594 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003595 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003596 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003597 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003598 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003599 }
3600 }
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003601 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003602}
3603
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003604/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003605/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3606/// locations.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003607ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003608Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003609 MultiExprArg args, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003610 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003611
3612 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003613 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003614 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3615 Fn = Result.take();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003616
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003617 Expr **Args = args.release();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003618
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003619 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003620 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3621 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3622 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3623 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3624 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003625 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003626 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3627 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003628
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003629 NumArgs = 0;
3630 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003631
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003632 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3633 RParenLoc));
3634 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003635
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003636 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003637 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003638 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3639 // Fn.
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003640 bool Dependent = false;
3641 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3642 Dependent = true;
3643 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3644 Dependent = true;
3645
3646 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003647 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003648 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3649
3650 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3651 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3652 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003653 RParenLoc));
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003654
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003655 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3656
3657 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3658 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3659 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3660 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3661 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3662 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3663 // method template.
3664 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003665 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3666 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor958aeb02009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003667 (void)MemE;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003668
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003669 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003670 RParenLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003671 }
3672
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003673 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003674 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003675 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003676 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003677 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003678 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003679 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003680
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003681 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003682 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003683 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD ||
3684 BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregor5f970ee2010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003685 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3686 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003687 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003688
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003689 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall
3690 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
3691 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3692 RParenLoc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003693
3694 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3695 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003696 TheCall, 0))
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003697 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8d6d90d2009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003698
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003699 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003700 RParenLoc))
3701 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003702
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003703 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003704 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003705 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003706 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3707 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003708 }
3709 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003710 }
3711
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003712 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003713 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor6db8ed42009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003714 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003715
Eli Friedmanefa42f72009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003716 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003717 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3718 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor1aae80b2010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003719 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003720 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003721 }
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003722
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003723 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3724 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3725 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3726
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003727 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3728}
3729
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003730/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3731/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003732/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3733/// block-pointer type.
3734///
3735/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003736ExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003737Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3738 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3739 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3740 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3741 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3742
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003743 // Promote the function operand.
3744 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3745
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003746 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3747 // of arguments and function on error.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003748 CallExpr *TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3749 Args, NumArgs,
3750 Context.BoolTy,
3751 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003752
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003753 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3754 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3755 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3756 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003757 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003758 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003759 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3760 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003761 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003762 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003763 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003764 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003765 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003766 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003767 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3768 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3769
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003770 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003771 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003772 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall,
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003773 FDecl))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003774 return ExprError();
3775
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003776 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003777 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003778
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003779 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003780 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003781 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003782 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003783 } else {
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003784 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003785
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003786 if (FDecl) {
3787 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3788 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3789 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis06a54a32010-07-07 11:31:19 +00003790 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003791 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003792 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003793 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3794 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3795 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3796 }
3797 }
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003798 }
3799
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003800 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003801 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3802 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3803 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003804 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3805 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003806 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3807 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003808 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003809 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003810 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003811 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003812
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003813 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3814 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003815 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3816 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003817
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003818 // Check for sentinels
3819 if (NDecl)
3820 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003821
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003822 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003823 if (FDecl) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003824 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003825 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003826
Douglas Gregor7814e6d2009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003827 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003828 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall);
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003829 } else if (NDecl) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003830 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003831 return ExprError();
3832 }
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003833
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003834 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003835}
3836
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003837ExprResult
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00003838Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003839 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003840 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroffaff1edd2007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003841 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003842 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003843
3844 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3845 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3846 if (!TInfo)
3847 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3848
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003849 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003850}
3851
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003852ExprResult
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003853Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003854 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *literalExpr) {
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003855 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Anders Carlssond35c8322007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003856
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003857 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003858 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003859 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3860 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor690dc7f2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003861 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3862 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003863 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003864 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003865 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003866 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003867
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003868 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregord6542d82009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003869 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003870 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003871 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003872 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003873 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003874 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCallca0408f2010-08-23 06:44:23 +00003875 MultiExprArg(*this, &literalExpr, 1),
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003876 &literalType);
3877 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003878 return ExprError();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003879 literalExpr = Result.get();
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003880
Chris Lattner371f2582008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003881 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003882 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003883 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003884 return ExprError();
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003885 }
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003886
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003887 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003888 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003889}
3890
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003891ExprResult
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003892Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003893 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3894 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003895 Expr **InitList = initlist.release();
Anders Carlsson66b5a8a2007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003896
Steve Naroff08d92e42007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003897 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003898 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003899
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003900 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3901 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003902 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003903 return Owned(E);
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003904}
3905
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003906static CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003907 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003908 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003909 return CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003910
3911 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3912 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003913 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003914 CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
3915 CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003916 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003917 return CK_PointerToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003918 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003919
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003920 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3921 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003922 return CK_IntegralCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003923 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003924 return CK_IntegralToPointer;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003925 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003926 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003927 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003928
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003929 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3930 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003931 return CK_FloatingCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003932 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003933 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003934 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003935
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003936 // FIXME: Assert here.
3937 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003938 return CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003939}
3940
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003941/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redlef0cb8e2009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003942bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003943 CastKind& Kind,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00003944 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahaniane9f42082009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003945 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003946 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003947 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3948 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003949
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003950 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003951
3952 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3953 // type needs to be scalar.
3954 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3955 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003956 Kind = CK_ToVoid;
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003957 return false;
3958 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003959
Eli Friedman8d438082010-07-17 20:43:49 +00003960 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
3961 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
3962 return true;
3963
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003964 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003965 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003966 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3967 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003968 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003969 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3970 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003971 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003972 return false;
3973 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003974
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003975 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003976 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003977 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003978 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003979 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003980 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003981 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003982 castExpr->getType())) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003983 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
3984 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3985 break;
3986 }
3987 }
3988 if (Field == FieldEnd)
3989 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
3990 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003991 Kind = CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003992 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003993 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003994
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003995 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
3996 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
3997 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
3998 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003999
4000 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004001 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004002 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4003 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004004 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004005 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004006
4007 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004008 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004009
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004010 if (castType->isVectorType())
4011 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
4012 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
4013 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
4014
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004015 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
4016 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004017
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004018 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004019 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004020 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor2ade35e2010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004021 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004022 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4023 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
4024 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4025 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004026 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004027 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4028 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
4029 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004030 }
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004031
4032 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
John McCallb7f4ffe2010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004033
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004034 if (Kind == CK_Unknown || Kind == CK_BitCast)
John McCallb7f4ffe2010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004035 CheckCastAlign(castExpr, castType, TyR);
4036
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004037 return false;
4038}
4039
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004040bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004041 CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004042 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004043
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004044 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004045 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004046 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004047 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004048 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004049 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004050 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004051 } else
4052 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004053 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004054 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004055
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004056 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004057 return false;
4058}
4059
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004060bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004061 CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004062 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004063
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004064 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004065
Nate Begeman9b10da62009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004066 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4067 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004068 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4069 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4070 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4071 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004072 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004073 return false;
4074 }
4075
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004076 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004077 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4078 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004079 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4080 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4081 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4082 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004083
4084 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4085 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
4086 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004087
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004088 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004089 return false;
4090}
4091
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004092ExprResult
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004093Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004094 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
4095 assert((Ty != 0) && (castExpr != 0) &&
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004096 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff16beff82007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004097
John McCall9d125032010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004098 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4099 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4100 if (!castTInfo)
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004101 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004102
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004103 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
4104 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004105 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, castExpr,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004106 castTInfo);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004107
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004108 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, castExpr);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004109}
4110
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004111ExprResult
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004112Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004113 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004114 CastKind Kind = CK_Unknown;
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004115 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004116 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004117 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004118 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson0aebc812009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004119
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004120 return Owned(CStyleCastExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004121 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004122 Kind, castExpr, &BasePath, Ty,
4123 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004124}
4125
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004126/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4127/// of comma binary operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004128ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004129Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *expr) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004130 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4131 if (!E)
4132 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004133
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004134 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004135
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004136 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004137 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
4138 E->getExpr(i));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004139
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004140 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4141
4142 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004143}
4144
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004145ExprResult
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004146Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004147 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Op,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004148 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004149 ParenListExpr *PE = cast<ParenListExpr>(Op);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004150 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004151 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004152
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004153 // Check for an altivec literal,
4154 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004155 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4156 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4157 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4158 return ExprError();
4159 }
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004160 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4161 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4162 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4163 }
4164 else
4165 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4166 }
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004167
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004168 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4169 // then handle it as such.
4170 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004171 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4172 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4173 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4174
4175 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4176 // braces instead of the original commas.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004177 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4178 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004179 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4180 E->setType(Ty);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004181 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, E);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004182 } else {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004183 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004184 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004185 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Op);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004186 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4187 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Result.take());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004188 }
4189}
4190
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004191ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004192 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004193 MultiExprArg Val,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004194 ParsedType TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004195 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4196 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004197 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4198 Expr *expr;
4199 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4200 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4201 else
4202 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004203 return Owned(expr);
4204}
4205
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004206/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4207/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004208/// C99 6.5.15
4209QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004210 Expr *&SAVE,
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004211 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004212 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4213 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004214 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, SAVE, QuestionLoc);
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004215
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004216 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004217 if (SAVE) {
4218 SAVE = LHS = Cond;
4219 }
4220 else
4221 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004222 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4223 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4224 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4225 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004226
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004227 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004228 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
Nate Begeman6155d732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004229 // OpenCL: Sec 6.3.i says the condition is allowed to be a vector or scalar.
4230 // Throw an error if its not either.
4231 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL) {
4232 if (!CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4233 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(),
4234 diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar_or_vector)
4235 << CondTy;
4236 return QualType();
4237 }
4238 }
4239 else {
4240 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4241 << CondTy;
4242 return QualType();
4243 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004244 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004245
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004246 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004247 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4248 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004249
Nate Begeman6155d732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004250 // OpenCL: If the condition is a vector, and both operands are scalar,
4251 // attempt to implicity convert them to the vector type to act like the
4252 // built in select.
4253 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL && CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4254 // Both operands should be of scalar type.
4255 if (!LHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4256 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4257 << CondTy;
4258 return QualType();
4259 }
4260 if (!RHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4261 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4262 << CondTy;
4263 return QualType();
4264 }
4265 // Implicity convert these scalars to the type of the condition.
4266 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4267 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4268 }
4269
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004270 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4271 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004272 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4273 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4274 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004275 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004276
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004277 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4278 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004279 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4280 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004281 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004282 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004283 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004284 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004285 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004286 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004287
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004288 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004289 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004290 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4291 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4292 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4293 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4294 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4295 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4296 << LHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004297 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
4298 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman0e724012008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004299 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004300 }
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004301 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4302 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004303 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004304 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004305 // promote the null to a pointer.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004306 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004307 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004308 }
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004309 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004310 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004311 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004312 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004313 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004314
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004315 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4316 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4317 QuestionLoc);
4318 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4319 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004320
4321
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004322 // Handle block pointer types.
4323 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4324 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4325 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4326 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004327 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
4328 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004329 return destType;
4330 }
4331 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004332 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004333 return QualType();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004334 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004335 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4336 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4337 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004338 return LHSTy;
4339 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004340 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004341 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4342 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004343
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004344 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4345 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004346 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004347 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004348 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4349 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4350 // to get a consistent AST.
4351 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004352 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4353 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004354 return incompatTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004355 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004356 // The block pointer types are compatible.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004357 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4358 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff91588042009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004359 return LHSTy;
4360 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004361
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004362 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4363 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4364 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004365 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4366 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004367
4368 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4369 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4370 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004371 QualType destPointee
4372 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004373 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004374 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004375 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004376 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004377 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004378 return destType;
4379 }
4380 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004381 QualType destPointee
4382 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004383 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004384 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004385 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004386 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004387 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004388 return destType;
4389 }
4390
4391 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4392 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4393 return LHSTy;
4394 }
4395 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4396 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4397 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4398 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4399 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4400 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4401 // to get a consistent AST.
4402 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004403 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4404 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004405 return incompatTy;
4406 }
4407 // The pointer types are compatible.
4408 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4409 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4410 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4411 // type.
4412 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4413 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004414 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4415 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004416 return LHSTy;
4417 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004418
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004419 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4420 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4421 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4422 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004423 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004424 return RHSTy;
4425 }
4426 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4427 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4428 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004429 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004430 return LHSTy;
4431 }
Daniel Dunbar5e155f02008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004432
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004433 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004434 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4435 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004436 return QualType();
4437}
4438
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004439/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4440/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4441QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4442 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4443 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4444 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004445
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004446 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4447 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4448 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4449 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4450 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004451 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004452 return LHSTy;
4453 }
4454 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4455 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004456 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004457 return RHSTy;
4458 }
4459 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4460 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4461 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004462 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004463 return LHSTy;
4464 }
4465 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4466 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004467 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004468 return RHSTy;
4469 }
4470 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4471 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4472 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004473 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004474 return LHSTy;
4475 }
4476 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4477 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004478 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004479 return RHSTy;
4480 }
4481 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4482 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004483
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004484 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4485 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4486 return LHSTy;
4487 }
4488 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4489 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4490 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004491
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004492 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4493 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4494 // type. This allows
4495 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4496 // where B is a subclass of A.
4497 //
4498 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4499 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4500 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4501 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004502
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004503 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4504 // It could return the composite type.
4505 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4506 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4507 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4508 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4509 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4510 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4511 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4512 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4513 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4514 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4515 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4516 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4517 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4518 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004519 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004520 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4521 ;
4522 else {
4523 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4524 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4525 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4526 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004527 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4528 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004529 return incompatTy;
4530 }
4531 // The object pointer types are compatible.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004532 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
4533 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004534 return compositeType;
4535 }
4536 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4537 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4538 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4539 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4540 QualType destPointee
4541 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4542 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4543 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004544 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004545 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004546 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004547 return destType;
4548 }
4549 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4550 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4551 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4552 QualType destPointee
4553 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4554 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4555 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004556 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004557 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004558 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004559 return destType;
4560 }
4561 return QualType();
4562}
4563
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004564/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004565/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004566ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004567 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004568 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
4569 Expr *RHSExpr) {
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004570 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4571 // was the condition.
4572 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
Fariborz Jahanianf9b949f2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004573 Expr *SAVEExpr = 0;
4574 if (isLHSNull) {
4575 LHSExpr = SAVEExpr = CondExpr;
4576 }
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004577
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004578 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
4579 SAVEExpr, QuestionLoc);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004580 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004581 return ExprError();
4582
Douglas Gregor47e1f7c2009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004583 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Fariborz Jahanianf9b949f2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004584 LHSExpr, ColonLoc,
4585 RHSExpr, SAVEExpr,
4586 result));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004587}
4588
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004589// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004590// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004591// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4592// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4593// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004594Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004595Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
4596 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004597
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004598 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4599 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4600 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4601 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4602 return Compatible;
4603 }
4604
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004605 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004606 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4607 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004608
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004609 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004610 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4611 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004612
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004613 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004614
4615 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4616 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4617 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianf11284a2009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004618 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004619 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004620 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004621
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004622 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4623 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004624 // version of void...
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004625 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004626 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004627 return ConvTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004628
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004629 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004630 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4631 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004632 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004633
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004634 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004635 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004636 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004637
4638 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004639 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4640 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004641 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004642 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004643 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004644 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4645 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4646 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4647 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4648 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4649 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004650 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004651 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004652 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004653 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004654
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004655 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004656 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004657 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004658 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004659
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004660 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4661 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4662 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4663 // warning can be disabled.
4664 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4665 return ConvTy;
4666 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4667 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004668
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004669 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4670 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4671 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4672 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4673 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4674 do {
4675 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4676 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004677
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004678 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4679 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4680 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004681
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004682 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004683 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004684 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004685
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004686 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004687 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004688 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004689 return ConvTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004690}
4691
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004692/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4693/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4694/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4695// types.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004696Sema::AssignConvertType
4697Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004698 QualType rhsType) {
4699 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004700
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004701 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004702 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4703 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004704
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004705 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4706 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4707 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004708
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004709 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004710
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004711 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004712 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004713 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004714
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004715 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4716 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4717 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4718 }
4719 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004720 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004721 return ConvTy;
4722}
4723
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004724/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4725/// for assignment compatibility.
4726Sema::AssignConvertType
4727Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004728 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4729 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004730 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4731 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004732 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004733 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004734 }
4735 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4736 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004737 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4738 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004739 return IncompatiblePointer;
4740 return Compatible;
4741 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004742 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004743 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004744 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004745 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4746 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4747 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4748 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4749 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4750 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004751
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004752 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4753 return Compatible;
4754 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4755 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004756 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004757}
4758
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004759/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4760/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004761/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4762///
4763/// int a, *pint;
4764/// short *pshort;
4765/// struct foo *pfoo;
4766///
4767/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4768/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4769/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4770/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4771///
4772/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004773/// C99 spec dictates.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004774///
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004775Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004776Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004777 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4778 // them.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004779 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4780 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004781
4782 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerd2656dd2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004783 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff700204c2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004784
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004785 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4786 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4787 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4788 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4789 return Compatible;
4790 }
4791
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004792 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4793 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4794 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4795 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4796 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4797 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4798 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004799 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004800 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson793680e2007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004801 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004802 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahanian411f3732007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004803 }
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004804 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4805 // to the same ExtVector type.
4806 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4807 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4808 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004809 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004810 return Compatible;
4811 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004812
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004813 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004814 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
4815 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
4816 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
4817 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
4818 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4819 (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)))
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004820 return IncompatibleVectors;
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004821
4822 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
4823 // vector type and vice versa
4824 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType))
4825 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnere8b3e962008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004826 }
4827 return Incompatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004828 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004829
Douglas Gregor88623ad2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004830 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4831 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004832 return Compatible;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004833
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004834 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004835 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004836 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004837
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004838 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004839 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004840
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004841 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004842 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004843 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4844 return Compatible;
4845 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004846 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004847 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4848 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004849 return Compatible;
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004850
4851 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004852 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004853 return Compatible;
4854 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004855 return Incompatible;
4856 }
4857
4858 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4859 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedmand8f4f432009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004860 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004861
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004862 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004863 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004864 return Compatible;
4865
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004866 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4867 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004868
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004869 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004870 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004871 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004872 }
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004873 return Incompatible;
4874 }
4875
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004876 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4877 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4878 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004879
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004880 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004881 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004882 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4883 return Compatible;
4884 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004885 }
4886 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004887 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004888 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004889 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004890 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4891 return Compatible;
4892 }
4893 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4894 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4895 return Compatible;
4896 return Incompatible;
4897 }
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004898 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004899 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004900 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4901 return Compatible;
4902
4903 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004904 return PointerToInt;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004905
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004906 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004907 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004908
4909 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004910 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004911 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004912 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004913 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004914 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4915 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4916 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4917 return Compatible;
4918
4919 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4920 return PointerToInt;
4921
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004922 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004923 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004924 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4925 return Compatible;
4926 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004927 }
4928 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004929 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004930 return Compatible;
4931 return Incompatible;
4932 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004933
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004934 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004935 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004936 return Compatible;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004937 }
4938 return Incompatible;
4939}
4940
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004941/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4942/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004943static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004944 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4945 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4946 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004947 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenekba7bc552010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004948 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004949 SourceLocation());
4950 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4951 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4952
4953 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4954 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004955 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004956 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004957 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004958}
4959
4960Sema::AssignConvertType
4961Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4962 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4963
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004964 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004965 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4966 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004967 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004968 return Incompatible;
4969
4970 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4971 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4972 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4973 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004974 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4975 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004976 it != itend; ++it) {
4977 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4978 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4979 // 1) void pointer
4980 // 2) null pointer constant
4981 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004982 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004983 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004984 InitField = *it;
4985 break;
4986 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004987
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004988 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004989 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004990 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004991 InitField = *it;
4992 break;
4993 }
4994 }
4995
4996 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
4997 == Compatible) {
Daniel Dunbar41e11a92010-09-17 23:21:43 +00004998 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004999 InitField = *it;
5000 break;
5001 }
5002 }
5003
5004 if (!InitField)
5005 return Incompatible;
5006
5007 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
5008 return Compatible;
5009}
5010
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005011Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005012Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005013 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5014 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
5015 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
5016 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
5017 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00005018 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005019 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005020 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner2c4463f2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00005021 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005022 }
5023
5024 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
5025 // structures.
5026 }
5027
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005028 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
5029 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005030 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
5031 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005032 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005033 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005034 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005035 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005036 return Compatible;
5037 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005038
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005039 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005040 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregor02a24ee2009-11-03 16:56:39 +00005041 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyc133e9e2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00005042 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005043 //
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005044 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005045 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005046 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005047
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005048 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
5049 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005050
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005051 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
5052 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00005053 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
5054 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
5055 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
5056 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005057 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00005058 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005059 CK_Unknown);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005060 return result;
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005061}
5062
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005063QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005064 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00005065 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005066 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005067 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005068}
5069
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005070QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005071 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005072 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005073 QualType lhsType =
5074 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5075 QualType rhsType =
5076 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005077
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005078 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005079 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005080 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005081
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005082 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5083 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005084 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005085 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chandler Carruth629f9e42010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005086 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005087 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005088 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005089 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005090 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005091 return lhsType;
5092 }
5093
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005094 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005095 return rhsType;
Eric Christophere84f9eb2010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005096 } else if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) ==Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)){
5097 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
5098 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a
5099 // bitcast; no bits are changed but the result type is different.
5100 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
5101 return lhsType;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005102 }
Eric Christophere84f9eb2010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005103 }
Chandler Carruth629f9e42010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005104 }
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005105 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005106
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005107 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
5108 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType() &&
5109 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005110 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005111 return rhsType;
5112 }
5113
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005114 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5115 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5116 bool swapped = false;
5117 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5118 swapped = true;
5119 std::swap(rex, lex);
5120 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5121 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005122
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005123 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005124 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005125 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005126 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005127 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005128 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005129 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5130 return lhsType;
5131 }
5132 }
5133 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5134 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5135 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005136 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005137 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5138 return lhsType;
5139 }
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005140 }
5141 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005142
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005143 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005144 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005145 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005146 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005147 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005148}
5149
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005150QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5151 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar69d1d002009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005152 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005153 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005154
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005155 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005156
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005157 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5158 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5159 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005160
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005161 // Check for division by zero.
5162 if (isDiv &&
5163 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005164 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005165 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005166
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005167 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005168}
5169
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005170QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005171 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005172 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005173 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5174 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005175 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5176 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5177 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005178
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005179 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005180
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005181 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5182 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005183
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005184 // Check for remainder by zero.
5185 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005186 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5187 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005188
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005189 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005190}
5191
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005192QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005193 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005194 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5195 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5196 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5197 return compType;
5198 }
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005199
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005200 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005201
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005202 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005203 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5204 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5205 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005206 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005207 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005208
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005209 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5210 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005211 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005212 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5213
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005214 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005215
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005216 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005217 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005218
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005219 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5220 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005221 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5222 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005223 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005224 return QualType();
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005225 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005226
5227 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5228 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5229 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005230 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005231 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5232 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5233 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5234 return QualType();
5235 }
5236
5237 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5238 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5239 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005240 } else {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005241 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005242 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005243 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005244 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5245 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005246 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5247 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005248 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005249 return QualType();
5250 }
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005251 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005252 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005253 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5254 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5255 return QualType();
5256 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005257
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005258 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005259 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5260 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5261 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5262 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5263 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005264 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005265 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5266 }
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005267 return PExp->getType();
5268 }
5269 }
5270
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005271 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005272}
5273
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005274// C99 6.5.6
5275QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005276 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5277 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5278 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5279 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5280 return compType;
5281 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005282
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005283 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005284
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005285 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005286
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005287 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005288 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5289 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005290 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005291 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005292 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005293
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005294 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005295 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff430ee5a2009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005296 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005297
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005298 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005299
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005300 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5301 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5302 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5303 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5304 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5305 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5306 return QualType();
5307 }
5308
5309 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5310 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5311 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5312 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5313 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005314 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005315 return QualType();
5316 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005317
5318 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5319 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5320 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005321 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005322 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005323 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005324 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005325 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005326
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005327 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005328 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005329 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5330 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5331 return QualType();
5332 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005333
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005334 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005335 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5336 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5337 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5338 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5339 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5340 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005341 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005342 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5343
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005344 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005345 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005346 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005347
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005348 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005349 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman8e54ad02008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005350 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005351
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005352 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5353 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5354 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5355 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5356 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5357 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5358 return QualType();
5359 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005360
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005361 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5362 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5363 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5364 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005365 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005366 return QualType();
5367 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005368
5369 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5370 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5371 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5372 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5373 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005374 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5375 << rex->getSourceRange()
5376 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005377 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005378
Eli Friedman88d936b2009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005379 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5380 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5381 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5382 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5383 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5384 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5385 return QualType();
5386 }
5387 } else {
5388 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5389 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5390 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5391 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5392 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5393 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5394 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5395 return QualType();
5396 }
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005397 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005398
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005399 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5400 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5401 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5402 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5403 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005404 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005405 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005406
5407 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005408 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5409 }
5410 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005411
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005412 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005413}
5414
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005415// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005416QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005417 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005418 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005419 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5420 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005421 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005422
Nate Begeman2207d792009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005423 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5424 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5425 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5426
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005427 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5428 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005429 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5430 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5431 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5432 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5433 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005434 }
Chris Lattner1dcf2c82007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005435 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005436 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005437
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005438 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005439
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005440 // Sanity-check shift operands
5441 llvm::APSInt Right;
5442 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar3f180c62009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005443 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5444 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn8045c732009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005445 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005446 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5447 else {
5448 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5449 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5450 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5451 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5452 }
5453 }
5454
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005455 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005456 return LHSTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005457}
5458
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005459static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
5460 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
5461 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
5462 return true;
5463 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
5464 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
5465 }
5466 return false;
5467}
5468
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005469// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005470QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005471 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005472 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc;
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005473
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005474 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005475 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005476 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005477
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005478 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5479 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005480
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005481 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
Ted Kremenekfbcb0eb2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005482 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational) &&
5483 !lex->getLocStart().isMacroID() &&
5484 !rex->getLocStart().isMacroID()) {
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005485 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5486 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5487 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth64d092c2010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005488 //
5489 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
5490 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
5491 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
5492 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
5493 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
5494 // result.
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005495 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5496 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005497 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005498 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Ted Kremenekfbcb0eb2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005499 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005500 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005501 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5502 << 0 // self-
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005503 << (Opc == BO_EQ
5504 || Opc == BO_LE
5505 || Opc == BO_GE));
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005506 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5507 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5508 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5509 // what is it always going to eval to?
5510 char always_evals_to;
5511 switch(Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005512 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005513 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5514 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005515 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005516 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5517 break;
5518 default:
5519 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5520 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5521 break;
5522 }
5523 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5524 << 1 // array
5525 << always_evals_to);
5526 }
5527 }
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005528 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005529
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005530 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5531 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5532 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5533 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005534
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005535 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5536 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005537 Expr *literalString = 0;
5538 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005539 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005540 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005541 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005542 literalString = lex;
5543 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005544 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5545 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005546 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005547 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005548 literalString = rex;
5549 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5550 }
5551
5552 if (literalString) {
5553 std::string resultComparison;
5554 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005555 case BO_LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5556 case BO_GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5557 case BO_LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5558 case BO_GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5559 case BO_EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5560 case BO_NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005561 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5562 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005563
Douglas Gregord1e4d9b2010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005564 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5565 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5566 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek03a4bee2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005567 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005568 }
Ted Kremenek3ca0bf22007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005569 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005570
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005571 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5572 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5573 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5574 else {
5575 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5576 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5577 }
5578
5579 lType = lex->getType();
5580 rType = rex->getType();
5581
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005582 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005583 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005584
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005585 if (isRelational) {
5586 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005587 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005588 } else {
Ted Kremenek72cb1ae2007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005589 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005590 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005591 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005592
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005593 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005594 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005595 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005596
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005597 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005598 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005599 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005600 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005601
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005602 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5603 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff77878cc2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005604 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005605 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005606 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005607 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005608 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005609
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005610 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005611 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5612 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005613 if (!isRelational &&
5614 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5615 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5616 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005617 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5618 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005619 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5620 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005621 Diag(Loc,
5622 isSFINAEContext()?
5623 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5624 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005625 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005626
5627 if (isSFINAEContext())
5628 return QualType();
5629
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005630 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005631 return ResultTy;
5632 }
5633 }
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005634 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5635 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5636 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5637 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5638 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5639 //
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005640 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005641 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005642 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005643 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005644 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005645 if (T.isNull()) {
5646 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5647 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5648 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005649 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005650 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005651 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005652 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005653 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005654 }
5655
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005656 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5657 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005658 return ResultTy;
5659 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005660 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5661 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5662 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5663 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5664 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5665 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5666 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5667 }
5668 } else if (!isRelational &&
5669 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5670 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5671 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5672 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5673 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5674 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5675 }
5676 } else {
5677 // Invalid
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005678 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005679 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005680 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005681 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005682 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005683 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe77fd3c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005684 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005685
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005686 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005687 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005688 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005689 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005690 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5691 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregor443c2122010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005692 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
5693 lType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005694 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5695 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005696 return ResultTy;
5697 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005698 if (LHSIsNull &&
5699 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5700 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregor443c2122010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005701 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
5702 rType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005703 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5704 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005705 return ResultTy;
5706 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005707
5708 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005709 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005710 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5711 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005712 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5713 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5714 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5715 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5716 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5717 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5718 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5719 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005720 // types.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005721 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005722 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005723 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005724 if (T.isNull()) {
5725 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005726 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005727 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005728 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005729 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005730 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005731 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005732 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005733 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005734
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005735 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5736 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005737 return ResultTy;
5738 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005739
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005740 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005741 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5742 return ResultTy;
5743 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005744
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005745 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005746 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005747 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5748 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005749
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005750 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedman26784c12009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005751 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005752 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005753 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005754 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005755 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005756 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005757 }
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005758 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005759 if (!isRelational
5760 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5761 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005762 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005763 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005764 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005765 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005766 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5767 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5768 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005769 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005770 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005771 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005772 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005773
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005774 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005775 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005776 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5777 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005778 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005779 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005780 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005781 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005782
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005783 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5784 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005785 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005786 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005787 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005788 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005789 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff87f3b932008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005790 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005791 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005792 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005793 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5794 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005795 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005796 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff20373222008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005797 }
Fariborz Jahanian7359f042007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005798 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005799 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5800 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005801 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005802 bool isError = false;
5803 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5804 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5805 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005806 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005807 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005808 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005809 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5810 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5811 isError = true;
5812 } else
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005813 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005814
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005815 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005816 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattner149f1382009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005817 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005818 if (isError)
5819 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005820 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005821
5822 if (lType->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005823 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005824 else
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005825 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005826 return ResultTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005827 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005828
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005829 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005830 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5831 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005832 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005833 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005834 }
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005835 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5836 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005837 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005838 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005839 }
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005840 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005841}
5842
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005843/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005844/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005845/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5846/// types.
5847QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005848 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005849 bool isRelational) {
5850 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5851 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005852 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005853 if (vType.isNull())
5854 return vType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005855
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005856 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5857 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005858
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005859 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5860 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5861 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005862 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005863 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5864 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5865 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005866 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5867 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5868 << 0 // self-
5869 << 2 // "a constant"
5870 );
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005871 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005872
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005873 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005874 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
5875 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005876 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005877 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005878
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005879 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5880 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5881 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005882 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005883 return lType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005884
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005885 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005886 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005887 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005888 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattnerd013aa12009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005889 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005890 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5891
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005892 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005893 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005894 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5895}
5896
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005897inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005898 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005899 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5900 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5901 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
5902 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5903
5904 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5905 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005906
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005907 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005908
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00005909 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005910 return compType;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005911 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005912}
5913
5914inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005915 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
5916
5917 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
5918 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
5919 // is a constant.
5920 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman787b0942010-07-27 19:14:53 +00005921 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattner23ef3e42010-07-15 00:26:43 +00005922 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005923 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
5924 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
5925 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
5926 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
5927 Expr::EvalResult Result;
5928 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
5929 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
5930 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
5931 << rex->getSourceRange()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005932 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
5933 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005934 }
5935 }
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005936
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005937 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5938 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5939 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005940
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005941 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5942 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005943
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005944 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson04905012009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005945 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005946
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005947 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
5948 // non-overloadable operands.
5949
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005950 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5951 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005952 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
5953 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
5954 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005955 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005956
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005957 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5958 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5959 // The result is a bool.
5960 return Context.BoolTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005961}
5962
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005963/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5964/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5965/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5966///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005967static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005968 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
5969 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
5970 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
5971 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005972 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005973 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
5974 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
5975 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
5976 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005977 }
5978 }
5979 return false;
5980}
5981
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005982/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
5983/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
5984static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005985 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005986 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00005987 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005988 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
5989 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005990 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
5991 return false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005992
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005993 unsigned Diag = 0;
5994 bool NeedType = false;
5995 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005996 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005997 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00005998 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
5999 NeedType = true;
6000 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006001 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006002 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6003 NeedType = true;
6004 break;
Chris Lattnerca354fa2008-11-17 19:51:54 +00006005 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006006 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
6007 break;
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006008 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
6009 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006010 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006011 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
6012 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006013 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6014 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006015 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
6016 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregor86447ec2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00006017 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006018 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00006019 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006020 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006021 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
6022 break;
Steve Naroff4f6a7d72008-09-26 14:41:28 +00006023 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006024 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6025 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5daf5702008-11-22 18:39:36 +00006026 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
6027 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
6028 break;
Fariborz Jahanianba8d2d62008-11-22 20:25:50 +00006029 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
6030 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
6031 break;
Fariborz Jahanian2514a302009-12-15 23:59:41 +00006032 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
6033 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
6034 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006035 }
Steve Naroffd1861fd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00006036
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006037 SourceRange Assign;
6038 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
6039 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006040 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006041 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006042 else
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006043 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006044 return true;
6045}
6046
6047
6048
6049// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006050QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
6051 SourceLocation Loc,
6052 QualType CompoundType) {
6053 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
6054 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006055 return QualType();
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006056
6057 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
6058 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006059 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006060 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006061 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006062 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006063 ConvertPropertyAssignment(LHS, RHS, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006064 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006065 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
6066 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
6067 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006068 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006069 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006070 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006071 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006072
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006073 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
6074 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
6075 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006076 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006077 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
6078 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
6079 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006080 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ||
6081 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006082 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006083 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006084 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
6085 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
6086 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattner3e872092009-03-09 07:11:10 +00006087 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
6088 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006089 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006090 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006091 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006092 }
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006093 }
6094 } else {
6095 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedman623712b2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00006096 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006097 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006098
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006099 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006100 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006101 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006102
Chris Lattner8b5dec32010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006103
6104 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6105 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6106 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6107 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6108 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6109 // check.
6110 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006111 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
Chris Lattner8b5dec32010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006112 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6113 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6114 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6115 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6116 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6117 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6118 }
6119
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006120 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6121 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006122 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006123 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6124 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006125 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006126 // operand.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006127 return LHSType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006128}
6129
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006130// C99 6.5.17
6131QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis25973452010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006132 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6133
Chris Lattner53fcaa92008-07-25 20:54:07 +00006134 // Comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1), but not unary conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006135 // C++ does not perform this conversion (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6136 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
6137 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006138
6139 // FIXME: Check that RHS type is complete in C mode (it's legal for it to be
6140 // incomplete in C++).
6141
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006142 return RHS->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006143}
6144
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006145/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6146/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006147QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006148 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006149 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6150 return Context.DependentTy;
6151
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006152 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6153 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006154
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006155 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6156 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6157 if (!isInc) {
6158 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6159 return QualType();
6160 }
6161 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6162 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6163 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006164 // OK!
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006165 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6166 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006167
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006168 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006169 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006170 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6171 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6172 << Op->getSourceRange();
6173 return QualType();
6174 }
6175
6176 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006177 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006178 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006179 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6180 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6181 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6182 return QualType();
6183 }
6184
6185 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006186 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006187 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006188 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006189 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006190 << ResType))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006191 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006192 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006193 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006194 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6195 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6196 return QualType();
6197 }
Eli Friedman5b088a12010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006198 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006199 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6200 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006201 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006202 } else {
6203 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006204 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006205 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006206 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006207 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroffdd10e022007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006208 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006209 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006210 return QualType();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006211 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6212 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6213 // operand.
6214 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6215 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006216}
6217
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006218void Sema::ConvertPropertyAssignment(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, QualType& LHSTy) {
6219 bool copyInit = false;
6220 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
6221 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
6222 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
6223 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
6224 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
6225 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
6226 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
6227 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
6228 }
6229 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHSTy->isRecordType());
6230 }
6231 else
6232 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(LHS) &&
6233 LHSTy->isRecordType());
6234 if (copyInit) {
6235 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006236 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006237 Expr *Arg = RHS;
6238 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(),
6239 Owned(Arg));
6240 if (!ArgE.isInvalid())
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006241 RHS = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006242 }
6243}
6244
6245
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006246/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006247/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006248/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6249/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6250/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6251/// - &(x) => x
6252/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6253/// - &s.xx => s
6254/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6255/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6256/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6257/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006258static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006259 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006260 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006261 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006262 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006263 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6264 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6265 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006266 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006267 return 0;
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006268 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006269 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006270 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006271 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6272 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006273 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6274 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6275 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6276 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6277 }
6278 return 0;
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006279 }
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006280 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6281 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006282
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006283 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006284 case UO_Real:
6285 case UO_Imag:
6286 case UO_Extension:
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006287 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6288 default:
6289 return 0;
6290 }
6291 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006292 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006293 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006294 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006295 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6296 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006297 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006298 default:
6299 return 0;
6300 }
6301}
6302
6303/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006304/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006305/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006306/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006307/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006308/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006309/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006310QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
6311 if (OrigOp->isTypeDependent())
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006312 return Context.DependentTy;
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006313 if (OrigOp->getType() == Context.OverloadTy)
6314 return Context.OverloadTy;
6315
6316 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6317 Expr *op = OrigOp->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006318
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006319 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6320 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6321 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006322 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006323 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6324 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6325 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6326 }
6327 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6328 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6329 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006330 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner28be73f2008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006331 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes6b6609f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006332
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006333 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006334 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6335 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6336 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6337 if (isSFINAEContext())
6338 return QualType();
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006339 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006340 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006341 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) {
6342 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer.
6343 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo.
6344
6345 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up.
6346 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
6347 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
6348 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6349 return QualType();
6350 }
6351 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
6352 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
6353
6354 // The id-expression was parenthesized.
6355 if (OrigOp != DRE) {
6356 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function)
6357 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6358
6359 // The method was named without a qualifier.
6360 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) {
6361 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6362 << op->getSourceRange();
6363 }
6364
6365 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6366 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6367 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006368 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006369 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006370 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006371 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006372 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6373 << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006374 return QualType();
6375 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006376 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006377 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6378 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6379 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006380 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson09380262010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006381 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006382 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006383 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemanb104b1f2009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006384 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006385 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian0337f212009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006386 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6387 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6388 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6389 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6390 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson1d524c32009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006391 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6392 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson474e1022009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006393 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6394 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006395 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006396 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006397 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6398 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4020f872010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006399 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
6400 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
John McCalld931b082010-08-26 03:08:43 +00006401 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register &&
Fariborz Jahanian4020f872010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006402 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006403 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6404 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006405 return QualType();
6406 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006407 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006408 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006409 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor29882052008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006410 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006411 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6412 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006413 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006414 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006415 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6416 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006417 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006418 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6419 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6420 return QualType();
6421 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006422
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006423 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6424 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006425 }
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006426 }
Anders Carlsson196f7d02009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006427 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006428 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006429 }
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006430
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006431 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6432 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6433 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6434 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6435 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6436 }
6437
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006438 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor8f70ddb2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00006439 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
6440 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006441 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
6442}
6443
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006444/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006445QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006446 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6447 return Context.DependentTy;
6448
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006449 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006450 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6451 QualType Result;
6452
6453 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6454 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6455 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6456 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6457 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6458 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6459 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6460 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6461 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006462
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006463 if (Result.isNull()) {
6464 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6465 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6466 return QualType();
6467 }
6468
6469 return Result;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006470}
6471
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006472static inline BinaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006473 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006474 BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006475 switch (Kind) {
6476 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006477 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
6478 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
6479 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break;
6480 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break;
6481 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break;
6482 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break;
6483 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break;
6484 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break;
6485 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break;
6486 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break;
6487 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break;
6488 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break;
6489 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break;
6490 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break;
6491 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break;
6492 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break;
6493 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break;
6494 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break;
6495 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
6496 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break;
6497 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break;
6498 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
6499 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
6500 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
6501 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
6502 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
6503 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
6504 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
6505 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
6506 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
6507 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
6508 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006509 }
6510 return Opc;
6511}
6512
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006513static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006514 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006515 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006516 switch (Kind) {
6517 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006518 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
6519 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
6520 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
6521 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break;
6522 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break;
6523 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break;
6524 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break;
6525 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break;
6526 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break;
6527 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break;
6528 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006529 }
6530 return Opc;
6531}
6532
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006533/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6534/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6535/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006536ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006537 unsigned Op,
6538 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006539 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006540 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) Op;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006541 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6542 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6543 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006544
6545 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006546 case BO_Assign:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006547 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6548 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006549 case BO_PtrMemD:
6550 case BO_PtrMemI:
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006551 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006552 Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006553 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006554 case BO_Mul:
6555 case BO_Div:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006556 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006557 Opc == BO_Div);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006558 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006559 case BO_Rem:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006560 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6561 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006562 case BO_Add:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006563 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6564 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006565 case BO_Sub:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006566 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6567 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006568 case BO_Shl:
6569 case BO_Shr:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006570 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6571 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006572 case BO_LE:
6573 case BO_LT:
6574 case BO_GE:
6575 case BO_GT:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006576 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006577 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006578 case BO_EQ:
6579 case BO_NE:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006580 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006581 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006582 case BO_And:
6583 case BO_Xor:
6584 case BO_Or:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006585 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6586 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006587 case BO_LAnd:
6588 case BO_LOr:
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006589 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006590 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006591 case BO_MulAssign:
6592 case BO_DivAssign:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006593 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006594 Opc == BO_DivAssign);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006595 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6596 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6597 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006598 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006599 case BO_RemAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006600 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6601 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6602 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6603 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006604 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006605 case BO_AddAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006606 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6607 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6608 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006609 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006610 case BO_SubAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006611 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6612 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6613 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006614 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006615 case BO_ShlAssign:
6616 case BO_ShrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006617 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6618 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6619 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6620 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006621 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006622 case BO_AndAssign:
6623 case BO_XorAssign:
6624 case BO_OrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006625 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6626 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6627 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6628 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006629 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006630 case BO_Comma:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006631 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6632 break;
6633 }
6634 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006635 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian57dae1a2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006636 if (ResultTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006637 if (Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign)
Fariborz Jahanian57dae1a2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006638 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_assignment_requires_nonfragile_object)
6639 << ResultTy;
6640 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006641 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006642 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6643 else
6644 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006645 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6646 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006647}
6648
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006649/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6650/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006651static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6652 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006653 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6654 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6655 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006656 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006657 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6658
6659 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6660 return;
6661
6662 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6663 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6664 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006665 return;
6666 }
6667
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006668 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6669 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006670 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006671
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006672 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006673 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006674
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006675 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6676 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6677 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6678 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006679 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006680 return;
6681 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006682
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006683 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006684 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6685 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006686}
6687
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006688/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6689/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6690/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6691/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006692static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006693 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006694 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6695 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6696 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6697 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006698 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006699 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006700 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6701
6702 // Subs are not binary operators.
6703 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6704 return;
6705
6706 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6707 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006708 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6709 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006710 return;
6711
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006712 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006713 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006714 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006715 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6716 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006717 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006718 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006719 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6720 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6721 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6722 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006723 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006724 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006725 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006726 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6727 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006728 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006729 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006730 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6731 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6732 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6733 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006734}
6735
6736/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6737/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6738/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006739static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006740 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006741 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006742 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6743}
6744
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006745// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006746ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006747 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6748 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
6749 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006750 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6751 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006752
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006753 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6754 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6755
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006756 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6757}
6758
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006759ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006760 BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
6761 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006762 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006763 ((!isa<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(lhs) &&
6764 !isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(lhs))
Fariborz Jahanianeb17e8b2010-09-17 20:45:45 +00006765 || rhs->isTypeDependent() || Opc != BO_Assign) &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006766 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006767 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6768 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6769 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6770 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6771 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006772 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006773 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006774 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6775 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6776 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006777
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006778 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6779 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006780 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006781 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006782
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006783 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006784 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006785}
6786
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006787ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006788 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006789 Expr *Input) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006790 UnaryOperatorKind Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperatorKind>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006791
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006792 QualType resultType;
6793 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006794 case UO_PreInc:
6795 case UO_PreDec:
6796 case UO_PostInc:
6797 case UO_PostDec:
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006798 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006799 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6800 Opc == UO_PostInc,
6801 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6802 Opc == UO_PreDec);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006803 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006804 case UO_AddrOf:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006805 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6806 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006807 case UO_Deref:
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006808 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006809 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
6810 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006811 case UO_Plus:
6812 case UO_Minus:
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006813 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6814 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006815 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6816 break;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006817 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6818 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006819 break;
6820 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6821 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6822 break;
6823 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006824 Opc == UO_Plus &&
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006825 resultType->isPointerType())
6826 break;
6827
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006828 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6829 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006830 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006831 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6832 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006833 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6834 break;
Chris Lattner02a65142008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006835 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6836 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6837 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006838 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006839 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006840 else if (!resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006841 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6842 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006843 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006844 case UO_LNot: // logical negation
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006845 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006846 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006847 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006848 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6849 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006850 if (!resultType->isScalarType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006851 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6852 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregorea844f32010-09-20 17:13:33 +00006853
6854 // Do not accept &f if f is overloaded
6855 // i.e. void f(int); void f(char); bool b = &f;
6856 if (resultType == Context.OverloadTy &&
6857 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Input))
6858 return ExprError(); // Diagnostic is uttered above
6859
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006860 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006861 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6862 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006863 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006864 case UO_Real:
6865 case UO_Imag:
6866 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006867 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006868 case UO_Extension:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006869 resultType = Input->getType();
6870 break;
6871 }
6872 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006873 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006874
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006875 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006876}
6877
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006878ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006879 UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
6880 Expr *Input) {
Anders Carlssona8a1e3d2009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006881 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
Eli Friedman957c0942010-09-05 23:15:52 +00006882 UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006883 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6884 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6885 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6886 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006887 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006888 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006889 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6890 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6891 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006892
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006893 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006894 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006895
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006896 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006897}
6898
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006899// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006900ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006901 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) {
6902 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input);
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006903}
6904
Steve Naroff1b273c42007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006905/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006906ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006907 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6908 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006909 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +00006910 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getCurFunction()->LabelMap[LabelII];
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006911
Daniel Dunbar0ffb1252008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006912 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6913 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroffcaaacec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006914 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006915 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006916
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00006917 LabelDecl->setUsed();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006918 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006919 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6920 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006921}
6922
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006923ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006924Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006925 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006926 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6927 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6928
Douglas Gregordd8f5692010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006929 bool isFileScope
6930 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattner4a049f02009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006931 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006932 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedmandca2b732009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006933
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006934 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6935 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
6936 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006937
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006938 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
6939 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
6940 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006941
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006942 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
6943 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
6944 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
6945 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
6946 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006947
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006948 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006949 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00006950 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006951
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006952 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
6953 // expressions are not lvalues.
6954
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006955 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006956}
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00006957
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006958ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006959 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006960 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
6961 unsigned NumComponents,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006962 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6963 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006964 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnarabd054db2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00006965 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006966
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006967 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
6968 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
6969 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006970 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006971 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
6972 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
6973
6974 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
6975 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
6976 if (!Dependent
6977 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
6978 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
6979 << TypeRange))
6980 return ExprError();
6981
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006982 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
6983 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00006984 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
6985 // a system header!
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00006986 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006987 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
6988 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00006989
6990 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
6991 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
6992 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
6993 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
6994 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
6995 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
6996 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
6997 if (OC.isBrackets) {
6998 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
6999 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7000 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
7001 if(!AT)
7002 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
7003 << CurrentType);
7004 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
7005 } else
7006 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7007
7008 // The expression must be an integral expression.
7009 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
7010 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
7011 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
7012 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
7013 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
7014 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
7015 << Idx->getSourceRange());
7016
7017 // Record this array index.
7018 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
7019 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
7020 continue;
7021 }
7022
7023 // Offset of a field.
7024 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7025 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
7026 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
7027 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
7028 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7029 continue;
7030 }
7031
7032 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
7033 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
7034 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
7035 return ExprError();
7036
7037 // Look for the designated field.
7038 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
7039 if (!RC)
7040 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7041 << CurrentType);
7042 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
7043
7044 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
7045 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
7046 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
7047 // (clause 9).
7048 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
7049 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
7050 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
7051 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
7052 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
7053 << CurrentType))
7054 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
7055 }
7056
7057 // Look for the field.
7058 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
7059 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
7060 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
7061 if (!MemberDecl)
7062 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
7063 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
7064 OC.LocEnd));
7065
Douglas Gregor9d5d60f2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00007066 // C99 7.17p3:
7067 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
7068 //
7069 // We diagnose this as an error.
7070 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
7071 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
7072 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
7073 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
7074 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
7075 return ExprError();
7076 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007077
7078 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
7079 bool AnonStructUnion = Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion();
7080 if (AnonStructUnion) {
7081 do {
7082 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(Parent->getParent());
7083 } while (Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
7084 }
7085
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007086 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
7087 // the base class indirections.
7088 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
7089 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007090 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007091 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
7092 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
7093 B != BEnd; ++B)
7094 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
7095 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007096
7097 if (AnonStructUnion) {
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007098 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
7099 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
7100 unsigned n = Path.size();
7101 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
7102 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
7103 } else {
7104 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
7105 }
7106 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
7107 }
7108
7109 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
7110 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
7111 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
7112}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007113
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007114ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007115 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7116 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007117 ParsedType argty,
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007118 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7119 unsigned NumComponents,
7120 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7121
7122 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
7123 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
7124 if (ArgTy.isNull())
7125 return ExprError();
7126
Eli Friedman5a15dc12010-08-05 10:15:45 +00007127 if (!ArgTInfo)
7128 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
7129
7130 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
7131 RPLoc);
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007132}
7133
7134
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007135ExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007136 ParsedType arg1,ParsedType arg2,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007137 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007138 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1;
7139 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1, &argTInfo1);
7140 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2;
7141 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2, &argTInfo2);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007142
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007143 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007144
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007145 return BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(BuiltinLoc, argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc);
7146}
7147
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007148ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007149Sema::BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7150 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1,
7151 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2,
7152 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Douglas Gregorc12a9c52009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007153 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7154 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7155 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7156 return ExprError();
7157 }
7158
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007159 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007160 argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007161}
7162
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007163
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007164ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007165 Expr *CondExpr,
7166 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007167 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007168 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7169
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007170 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007171 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregorc9ecc572009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007172 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007173 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007174 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007175 } else {
7176 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7177 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7178 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7179 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007180 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7181 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7182 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007183
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007184 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7185 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007186 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7187 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007188 }
7189
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007190 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007191 resType, RPLoc,
7192 resType->isDependentType(),
7193 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007194}
7195
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007196//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7197// Clang Extensions.
7198//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7199
7200/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007201void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007202 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7203 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7204 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007205 if (BlockScope)
7206 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7207 else
7208 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007209}
7210
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007211void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007212 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007213 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007214
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007215 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007216 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007217 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007218
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007219 bool isVariadic;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007220 QualType RetTy;
7221 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007222 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007223 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007224 isVariadic =
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007225 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7226 } else {
7227 RetTy = T;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007228 isVariadic = false;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007229 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007230
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007231 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007232
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007233 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7234 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7235 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007236 return;
7237 }
7238
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007239 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7240 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7241 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7242 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7243 return;
7244 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007245
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007246 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007247 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7248 // ^ * { ... }
7249 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007250 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7251 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007252
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007253 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007254 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007255 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7256 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7257 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7258 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007259 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7260 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7261 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7262 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7263 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007264 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007265 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007266
7267 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7268 // ^ fntype { ... }
7269 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7270 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7271 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7272 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7273 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7274 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7275 *I);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007276 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007277 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007278 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007279
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007280 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7281 if (!Params.empty())
7282 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007283
7284 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor9cdda0c2009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007285 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007286
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007287 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007288 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7289 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7290 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7291 }
7292
7293 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7294 // if we don't have any.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007295 if (Params.empty())
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007296 return;
7297
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007298 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7299 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7300
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007301 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007302 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7303 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7304
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007305 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007306 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7307 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7308 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7309
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007310 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007311 }
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007312 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007313}
7314
7315/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7316/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7317void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007318 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner5c59e2b2009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007319 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007320 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007321 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007322}
7323
7324/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7325/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007326ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007327 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9af55002009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007328 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7329 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7330 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007331
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007332 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007333
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007334 PopDeclContext();
7335
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007336 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007337 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7338 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007339
Mike Stump56925862009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007340 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007341 QualType BlockTy;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007342
7343 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7344 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7345 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7346
7347 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7348 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7349
7350 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7351 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7352 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7353 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7354
7355 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7356 // preserve its sugar structure.
7357 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7358 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7359 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7360
7361 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7362 } else {
7363 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7364 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7365 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7366 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7367 FPT->isVariadic(),
7368 /*quals*/ 0,
7369 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7370 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7371 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7372 FPT->exception_begin(),
7373 Ext);
7374 }
7375
7376 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7377 } else {
7378 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7379 false, false, 0, 0,
7380 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7381 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007382
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007383 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007384 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7385 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007386 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007387
Chris Lattner17a78302009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007388 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007389 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007390 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007391
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007392 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007393
7394 bool Good = true;
7395 // Check goto/label use.
7396 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7397 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7398 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7399
7400 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7401 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007402 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0) {
7403 if (!L->isUsed())
7404 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::warn_unused_label) << L->getName();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007405 continue;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007406 }
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007407
7408 // Emit error.
7409 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7410 Good = false;
7411 }
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007412 if (!Good) {
7413 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007414 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007415 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007416
John McCalle0054f62010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007417 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7418 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
7419
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007420 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenekd064fdc2010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007421 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7422 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
John McCalle0054f62010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007423 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, Result);
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007424
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007425 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007426 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007427}
7428
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007429ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007430 Expr *expr, ParsedType type,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007431 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007432 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
7433 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type, &TInfo);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007434 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, expr, TInfo, RPLoc);
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007435}
7436
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007437ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007438 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007439 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007440 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007441
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007442 // Get the va_list type
7443 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007444 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7445 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7446 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7447 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007448 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007449 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7450 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7451 } else {
7452 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7453 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007454 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007455 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007456 return ExprError();
7457 }
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007458
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007459 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7460 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007461 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7462 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007463 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9dc8f192009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007464 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007465
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007466 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007467 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007468
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007469 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7470 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T));
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007471}
7472
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007473ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007474 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7475 // pointers on the target.
7476 QualType Ty;
7477 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7478 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7479 else
7480 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7481
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007482 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007483}
7484
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007485static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007486 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007487 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7488 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007489
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007490 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7491 if (!PT)
7492 return;
7493
7494 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7495 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7496 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7497 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7498 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7499 return;
7500 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007501
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007502 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7503 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7504 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7505 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007506
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007507 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007508}
7509
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007510bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7511 SourceLocation Loc,
7512 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007513 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7514 bool *Complained) {
7515 if (Complained)
7516 *Complained = false;
7517
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007518 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7519 bool isInvalid = false;
7520 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007521 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007522
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007523 switch (ConvTy) {
7524 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7525 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007526 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007527 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7528 break;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007529 case IntToPointer:
7530 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7531 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007532 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007533 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007534 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7535 break;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007536 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7537 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7538 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007539 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7540 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7541 break;
7542 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007543 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7544 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7545 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7546 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7547 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7548 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7549 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7550 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7551 // C++ semantics.
7552 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7553 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7554 return false;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007555 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7556 break;
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007557 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanian3451e922009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007558 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007559 break;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007560 case IntToBlockPointer:
7561 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7562 break;
7563 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stump25efa102009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007564 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007565 break;
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007566 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007567 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007568 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7569 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7570 break;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007571 case IncompatibleVectors:
7572 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7573 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007574 case Incompatible:
7575 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7576 isInvalid = true;
7577 break;
7578 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007579
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007580 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7581 switch (Action) {
7582 case AA_Assigning:
7583 case AA_Initializing:
7584 // The destination type comes first.
7585 FirstType = DstType;
7586 SecondType = SrcType;
7587 break;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007588
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007589 case AA_Returning:
7590 case AA_Passing:
7591 case AA_Converting:
7592 case AA_Sending:
7593 case AA_Casting:
7594 // The source type comes first.
7595 FirstType = SrcType;
7596 SecondType = DstType;
7597 break;
7598 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007599
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007600 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007601 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007602 if (Complained)
7603 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007604 return isInvalid;
7605}
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007606
Chris Lattner3bf68932009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007607bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007608 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7609 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7610 if (Result)
7611 *Result = ICEResult;
7612 return false;
7613 }
7614
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007615 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7616
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007617 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007618 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7619 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7620
7621 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7622 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7623 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7624 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7625 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7626 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7627 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007628
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007629 return true;
7630 }
7631
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007632 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7633 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007634
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007635 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7636 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7637 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007638
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007639 if (Result)
7640 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7641 return false;
7642}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007643
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007644void
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007645Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007646 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7647 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007648}
7649
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007650void
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007651Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7652 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7653 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7654 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007655
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007656 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7657 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7658 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7659 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7660 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007661 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007662 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7663 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7664 I != IEnd; ++I)
7665 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7666 }
7667
7668 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7669 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7670 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7671 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7672 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7673 I != IEnd; ++I)
7674 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7675 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007676 }
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007677
7678 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7679 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7680 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7681 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007682 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007683 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7684 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7685 ExprTemporaries.end());
7686
7687 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7688 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007689}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007690
7691/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7692///
7693/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7694/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7695/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7696/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7697///
7698/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7699///
7700/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7701void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7702 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007703
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007704 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007705 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007706
Douglas Gregorb5352cf2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007707 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7708 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7709 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7710 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007711 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007712 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007713 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007714 return;
7715 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007716
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007717 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7718 return;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007719
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007720 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7721 // an instantiation.
7722 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7723 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007724
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007725 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007726 case Unevaluated:
7727 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7728 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007729
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007730 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7731 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7732 // "used"; handle this below.
7733 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007734
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007735 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7736 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7737 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7738 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007739 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007740 return;
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007741
7742 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
7743 // Referenced declarations will only be used if the construct in the
7744 // containing expression is used.
7745 return;
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007746 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007747
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007748 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanianb7f4cc02009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007749 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007750 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian05a5c452009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007751 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Chandler Carruth4e6fbce2010-08-23 07:55:51 +00007752 if (Constructor->getParent()->hasTrivialConstructor())
7753 return;
7754 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
7755 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007756 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor9e9199d2009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007757 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007758 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007759 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7760 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007761
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007762 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007763 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007764 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007765 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007766 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7767 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007768 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7769 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7770 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007771 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor39957dc2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007772 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007773 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7774 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007775 }
Fariborz Jahanianf5ed9e02009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007776 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007777 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor1637be72009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007778 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor6cfacfe2010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007779 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007780 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7781 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7782 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7783 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7784 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007785 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007786 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007787 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007788 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007789 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7790 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7791 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007792 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007793 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007794 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7795 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007796
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007797 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7798 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7799 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7800 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7801 Loc));
7802 else
Chandler Carruth62c78d52010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007803 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function, Loc));
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007804 }
Gabor Greif40181c42010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007805 } else // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable.
7806 for (FunctionDecl::redecl_iterator i(Function->redecls_begin()),
7807 e(Function->redecls_end()); i != e; ++i) {
Gabor Greifbe9ebe32010-08-28 01:58:12 +00007808 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable())
Gabor Greif40181c42010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007809 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *i);
7810 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007811
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007812 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Argyrios Kyrtzidis58b52592010-08-25 10:34:54 +00007813
7814 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function.
7815 if (CurContext != Function)
7816 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007817
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007818 return;
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007819 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007820
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007821 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007822 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007823 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007824 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7825 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7826 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7827 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7828 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7829 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Chandler Carruth62c78d52010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007830 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007831 }
7832 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007833
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007834 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007835
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007836 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007837 return;
Sam Weinigcce6ebc2009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007838 }
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007839}
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007840
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007841namespace {
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007842 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007843 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007844 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007845 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7846 Sema &S;
7847 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007848
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007849 public:
7850 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007851
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007852 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007853
7854 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7855 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007856 };
7857}
7858
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007859bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
7860 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007861 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7862 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7863 }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007864
7865 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007866}
7867
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007868bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007869 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7870 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7871 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007872 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7873 Args.flat_size());
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007874 }
7875
Chandler Carruthe3e210c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00007876 return true;
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007877}
7878
7879void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7880 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007881 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007882}
7883
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007884namespace {
7885 /// \brief Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by
7886 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
7887 class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> {
7888 Sema &S;
7889
7890 public:
7891 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited;
7892
7893 explicit EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S) : Inherited(S.Context), S(S) { }
7894
7895 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
7896 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
7897 }
7898
7899 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
7900 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getMemberLoc(), E->getMemberDecl());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007901 Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007902 }
7903
7904 void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) {
7905 if (E->getConstructor())
7906 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
7907 if (E->getOperatorNew())
7908 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorNew());
7909 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
7910 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007911 Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007912 }
7913
7914 void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) {
7915 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
7916 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor5833b0b2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00007917 QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType());
7918 if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) {
7919 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl());
7920 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(),
7921 S.LookupDestructor(Record));
7922 }
7923
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007924 Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007925 }
7926
7927 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) {
7928 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007929 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007930 }
7931
7932 void VisitBlockDeclRefExpr(BlockDeclRefExpr *E) {
7933 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
7934 }
7935 };
7936}
7937
7938/// \brief Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any
7939/// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
7940void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E) {
7941 EvaluatedExprMarker(*this).Visit(E);
7942}
7943
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007944/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
7945/// of the program being compiled.
7946///
7947/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007948/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007949/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
7950/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
7951/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
7952/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007953/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007954/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007955///
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007956/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
7957/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
7958/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
7959/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007960bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007961 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
7962 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
7963 case Unevaluated:
7964 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
7965 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007966
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007967 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007968 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007969 Diag(Loc, PD);
7970 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007971
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00007972 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7973 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
7974 break;
7975 }
7976
7977 return false;
7978}
7979
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007980bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
7981 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
7982 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
7983 return false;
7984
7985 PartialDiagnostic Note =
7986 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
7987 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
7988 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007989
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007990 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007991 FD ?
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007992 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
7993 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007994 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007995 << CE->getSourceRange(),
7996 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
7997 return true;
7998
7999 return false;
8000}
8001
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008002// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
8003// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
8004void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
8005 SourceLocation Loc;
8006
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008007 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
8008
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008009 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
8010 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008011 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign)
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008012 return;
8013
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008014 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
8015 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
8016 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
8017 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
8018
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008019 // self = [<foo> init...]
8020 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
8021 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
8022 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8023
8024 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
8025 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
8026 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
8027 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8028 }
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008029
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008030 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8031 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
8032 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
8033 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
8034 return;
8035
8036 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8037 } else {
8038 // Not an assignment.
8039 return;
8040 }
8041
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008042 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCall2d152152009-10-12 22:25:59 +00008043 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008044
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008045 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00008046 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008047 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008048 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
8049 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
8050 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008051}
8052
8053bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8054 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
8055
8056 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00008057 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008058
8059 QualType T = E->getType();
8060
8061 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
8062 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
8063 return true;
8064 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
8065 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
8066 << T << E->getSourceRange();
8067 return true;
8068 }
8069 }
8070
8071 return false;
8072}
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008073
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008074ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
8075 Expr *Sub) {
Douglas Gregoreecf38f2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00008076 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008077 return ExprError();
8078
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +00008079 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008080 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008081
8082 return Owned(Sub);
8083}